From 26a4cb66b9dbfa2d3d0faaf008becb1ab4270208 Mon Sep 17 00:00:00 2001 From: Alexey Zelkin Date: Mon, 15 Nov 1999 23:10:44 +0000 Subject: Deactivate manpages repo-copied to man4 directory (all these drivers not i386 specific anymore -- move them to appropriate place) --- share/man/man4/man4.i386/Makefile | 64 +-- share/man/man4/man4.i386/ahc.4 | 251 ---------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/al.4 | 152 ------ share/man/man4/man4.i386/atkbd.4 | 208 -------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/atkbdc.4 | 112 ----- share/man/man4/man4.i386/ax.4 | 155 ------ share/man/man4/man4.i386/de.4 | 119 ----- share/man/man4/man4.i386/dm.4 | 150 ------ share/man/man4/man4.i386/fdc.4 | 70 --- share/man/man4/man4.i386/fxp.4 | 96 ---- share/man/man4/man4.i386/keyboard.4 | 152 ------ share/man/man4/man4.i386/mem.4 | 193 -------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/mouse.4 | 382 --------------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/mtio.4 | 299 ------------ share/man/man4/man4.i386/mx.4 | 173 ------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/ncr.4 | 46 -- share/man/man4/man4.i386/ohci.4 | 70 --- share/man/man4/man4.i386/pcm.4 | 202 -------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/pcvt.4 | 917 ------------------------------------ share/man/man4/man4.i386/pn.4 | 160 ------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/psm.4 | 771 ------------------------------ share/man/man4/man4.i386/rl.4 | 192 -------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/screen.4 | 166 ------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/sf.4 | 161 ------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/si.4 | 163 ------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/sio.4 | 324 ------------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/sis.4 | 149 ------ share/man/man4/man4.i386/sk.4 | 159 ------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/splash.4 | 242 ---------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/ste.4 | 149 ------ share/man/man4/man4.i386/syscons.4 | 495 ------------------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/sysmouse.4 | 463 ------------------ share/man/man4/man4.i386/ti.4 | 192 -------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/tl.4 | 127 ----- share/man/man4/man4.i386/uhci.4 | 70 --- share/man/man4/man4.i386/ukbd.4 | 168 ------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/umass.4 | 104 ---- share/man/man4/man4.i386/ums.4 | 123 ----- share/man/man4/man4.i386/usb.4 | 298 ------------ share/man/man4/man4.i386/vga.4 | 170 ------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/vr.4 | 165 ------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/wb.4 | 159 ------- share/man/man4/man4.i386/xl.4 | 177 ------- 43 files changed, 10 insertions(+), 9148 deletions(-) delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/ahc.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/al.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/atkbd.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/atkbdc.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/ax.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/de.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/dm.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/fdc.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/fxp.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/keyboard.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/mem.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/mouse.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/mtio.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/mx.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/ncr.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/ohci.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/pcm.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/pcvt.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/pn.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/psm.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/rl.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/screen.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/sf.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/si.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/sio.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/sis.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/sk.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/splash.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/ste.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/syscons.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/sysmouse.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/ti.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/tl.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/uhci.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/ukbd.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/umass.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/ums.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/usb.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/vga.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/vr.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/wb.4 delete mode 100644 share/man/man4/man4.i386/xl.4 diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/Makefile b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/Makefile index ebd875e5d9e9..8de20fc5599f 100644 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/Makefile +++ b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/Makefile @@ -1,111 +1,67 @@ # $FreeBSD$ -MAN4= adv.4 adw.4 aha.4 ahb.4 ahc.4 aic.4 al.4 alpm.4 apm.4 ar.4 asc.4 \ - atkbd.4 atkbdc.4 ax.4 bktr.4 bt.4 cs.4 cx.4 cy.4 de.4 \ - dgb.4 dm.4 dpt.4 ed.4 el.4 en.4 ep.4 ex.4 fdc.4 fe.4 fxp.4 gsc.4 \ - ie.4 io.4 joy.4 keyboard.4 labpc.4 le.4 lnc.4 matcd.4 mcd.4 \ - mem.4 meteor.4 mouse.4 mse.4 mtio.4 mx.4 ncr.4 npx.4 \ - ohci.4 pcf.4 pcm.4 pcvt.4 perfmon.4 pn.4 pnp.4 ppc.4 psm.4 \ - rdp.4 rl.4 sb.4 scd.4 screen.4 sf.4 si.4 sio.4 sis.4 sk.4 \ - spkr.4 splash.4 sr.4 ste.4 syscons.4 sysmouse.4 ti.4 tl.4 tw.4 \ - tx.4 uhci.4 ukbd.4 umass.4 ums.4 usb.4 vga.4 vr.4 vx.4 \ - wb.4 wd.4 wfd.4 wi.4 wl.4 wt.4 xl.4 ze.4 zp.4 +MAN4= adv.4 adw.4 aha.4 ahb.4 aic.4 alpm.4 apm.4 ar.4 asc.4 \ + bktr.4 bt.4 cs.4 cx.4 cy.4 \ + dgb.4 dpt.4 ed.4 el.4 en.4 ep.4 ex.4 fe.4 gsc.4 \ + ie.4 io.4 joy.4 labpc.4 le.4 lnc.4 matcd.4 mcd.4 \ + meteor.4 mse.4 npx.4 \ + pcf.4 perfmon.4 pnp.4 ppc.4 \ + rdp.4 sb.4 scd.4 \ + spkr.4 sr.4 tw.4 \ + tx.4 vx.4 \ + wd.4 wfd.4 wi.4 wl.4 wt.4 ze.4 zp.4 MLINKS= adv.4 ../adv.4 MLINKS+= adw.4 ../adw.4 MLINKS+= aha.4 ../aha.4 MLINKS+= ahb.4 ../ahb.4 -MLINKS+= ahc.4 ../ahc.4 MLINKS+= aic.4 ../aic.4 -MLINKS+= al.4 ../al.4 MLINKS+= alpm.4 ../alpm.4 MLINKS+= apm.4 ../apm.4 MLINKS+= ar.4 ../ar.4 MLINKS+= asc.4 ../asc.4 -MLINKS+= atkbd.4 ../atkbd.4 -MLINKS+= atkbdc.4 ../atkbdc.4 -MLINKS+= ax.4 ../ax.4 MLINKS+= bktr.4 ../bktr.4 MLINKS+= bt.4 ../bt.4 MLINKS+= cs.4 ../cs.4 MLINKS+= cx.4 ../cx.4 MLINKS+= cy.4 ../cy.4 -MLINKS+= de.4 ../de.4 MLINKS+= dgb.4 ../dgb.4 -MLINKS+= dm.4 ../dm.4 MLINKS+= dpt.4 ../dpt.4 MLINKS+= ed.4 ../ed.4 MLINKS+= el.4 ../el.4 MLINKS+= en.4 ../en.4 MLINKS+= ep.4 ../ep.4 MLINKS+= ex.4 ../ex.4 -MLINKS+= fdc.4 ../fdc.4 MLINKS+= fe.4 ../fe.4 -MLINKS+= fxp.4 ../fxp.4 MLINKS+= gsc.4 ../gsc.4 MLINKS+= ie.4 ../ie.4 MLINKS+= io.4 ../io.4 MLINKS+= joy.4 ../joy.4 -MLINKS+= keyboard.4 ../keyboard.4 MLINKS+= labpc.4 ../labpc.4 MLINKS+= le.4 ../le.4 MLINKS+= lnc.4 ../lnc.4 MLINKS+= matcd.4 ../matcd.4 MLINKS+= mcd.4 ../mcd.4 -MLINKS+= mem.4 kmem.4 mem.4 ../mem.4 mem.4 ../kmem.4 MLINKS+= meteor.4 ../meteor.4 -MLINKS+= mouse.4 ../mouse.4 MLINKS+= mse.4 ../mse.4 -MLINKS+= mtio.4 ../mtio.4 -MLINKS+= mx.4 ../mx.4 -MLINKS+= ncr.4 ../ncr.4 MLINKS+= npx.4 ../npx.4 -MLINKS+= ohci.4 ../ohci.4 MLINKS+= pcf.4 ../pcf.4 -MLINKS+= pcm.4 ../pcm.4 -MLINKS+= pcvt.4 vt.4 pcvt.4 ../pcvt.4 pcvt.4 ../vt.4 MLINKS+= perfmon.4 ../perfmon.4 -MLINKS+= pn.4 ../pn.4 MLINKS+= pnp.4 ../pnp.4 MLINKS+= ppc.4 ../ppc.4 -MLINKS+= psm.4 ../psm.4 MLINKS+= rdp.4 ../rdp.4 -MLINKS+= rl.4 ../rl.4 MLINKS+= sb.4 ../sb.4 MLINKS+= scd.4 ../scd.4 -MLINKS+= screen.4 ../screen.4 -MLINKS+= sf.4 ../sf.4 -MLINKS+= si.4 ../si.4 -MLINKS+= sio.4 ../sio.4 -MLINKS+= sis.4 ../sis.4 -MLINKS+= sk.4 ../sk.4 MLINKS+= spkr.4 ../spkr.4 spkr.4 speaker.4 spkr.4 ../speaker.4 -MLINKS+= splash.4 ../splash.4 \ - splash.4 screensaver.4 splash.4 ../screensaver.4 MLINKS+= sr.4 ../sr.4 -MLINKS+= ste.4 ../ste.4 -MLINKS+= syscons.4 ../syscons.4 \ - syscons.4 sc.4 syscons.4 ../sc.4 -MLINKS+= sysmouse.4 ../sysmouse.4 -MLINKS+= ti.4 ../ti.4 -MLINKS+= tl.4 ../tl.4 MLINKS+= tw.4 ../tw.4 MLINKS+= tx.4 ../tx.4 -MLINKS+= uhci.4 ../uhci.4 -MLINKS+= ukbd.4 ../ukbd.4 -MLINKS+= umass.4 ../umass.4 -MLINKS+= ums.4 ../ums.4 -MLINKS+= usb.4 ../usb.4 -MLINKS+= vga.4 ../vga.4 -MLINKS+= vr.4 ../vr.4 MLINKS+= vx.4 ../vx.4 -MLINKS+= wb.4 ../wb.4 MLINKS+= wd.4 ../wd.4 MLINKS+= wfd.4 ../wfd.4 MLINKS+= wi.4 ../wi.4 MLINKS+= wl.4 ../wl.4 MLINKS+= wt.4 ../wt.4 -MLINKS+= xl.4 ../xl.4 MLINKS+= ze.4 ../ze.4 MLINKS+= zp.4 ../zp.4 diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ahc.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ahc.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 07f554b382f8..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ahc.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,251 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998 -.\" Justin T. Gibbs. All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products -.\" derived from this software without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd October 15, 1998 -.Dt AHC 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm ahc -.Nd Adaptec VL/EISA/PCI SCSI host adapter driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -For one or more VL/EISA cards: -.Cd controller eisa0 -.Cd controller ahc0 -.Pp -For one or more PCI cards: -.Cd controller pci0 -.Cd controller ahc0 -.Pp -To allow PCI adapters to use memory mapped I/O if enabled: -.Cd options AHC_ALLOW_MEMIO -.Pp -For one or more SCSI busses: -.Cd controller scbus0 at ahc0 -.Sh DESCRIPTION -This driver provides access to the -.Tn SCSI -bus(es) connected to Adaptec -.Tn AIC7770, -.Tn AIC7850, -.Tn AIC7860, -.Tn AIC7870, -.Tn AIC7880, -.Tn AIC7890, -.Tn AIC7891, -.Tn AIC7895, -.Tn AIC7896, -or -.Tn AIC7897 -host adapter chips. -These chips are found on many motherboards as well as the following -Adaptec SCSI controller cards: -.Tn 274X(W), -.Tn 274X(T), -.Tn 284X, -.Tn 2920C, -.Tn 2930U2, -.Tn 2940, -.Tn 2940U, -.Tn 2940AU, -.Tn 2940UW, -.Tn 2940UW Dual, -.Tn 2940U2W, -.Tn 2940U2B, -.Tn 2950U2W, -.Tn 2950U2B, -.Tn 3940, -.Tn 3940U, -.Tn 3940AU, -.Tn 3940UW, -.Tn 3940AUW, -.Tn 3940U2W, -.Tn 3950U2, -and -.Tn 3985. -.Pp -Driver features include support for twin and wide busses, -fast, ultra and ultra2 synchronous transfers depending on controller type, -tagged queuing, -and SCB paging. -.Pp -Memory mapped I/O can be enabled for PCI devices with the -.Dq Dv AHC_ALLOW_MEMIO -configuration option. -Memory mapped I/O is more efficient than the alternative, programmed I/O. -Most PCI BIOSes will map devices so that either technique for communicating -with the card is available. -In some cases, -usually when the PCI device is sitting behind a PCI->PCI bridge, -the BIOS fails to properly initialize the chip for memory mapped I/O. -The symptom of this problem is usually a system hang if memory mapped I/O -is attempted. -Most modern motherboards perform the initialization correctly and work fine -with this option enabled. -.Pp -Per target configuration performed in the -.Tn SCSI-Select -menu, accessible at boot -in -.No non- Ns Tn EISA -models, -or through an -.Tn EISA -configuration utility for -.Tn EISA -models, -is honored by this driver with the stipulation that the -.Tn BIOS -must be enabled for -.Tn EISA -adaptors. This includes synchronous/asynchronous transfers, -maximum synchronous negotiation rate, -disconnection, -the host adapter's SCSI ID, -and, -in the case of -.Tn EISA -Twin Channel controllers, -the primary channel selection. -.Pp -Note that I/O addresses are determined automatically by the probe routines, -but care should be taken when using a 284x -.Pq Tn VESA No local bus controller -in an -.Tn EISA -system. Ensure that the jumpers setting the I/O area for the 284x match the -.Tn EISA -slot into which the card is inserted to prevent conflicts with other -.Tn EISA -cards. -.Pp -Performance and feature sets vary throughout the aic7xxx product line. -The following table provides a comparison of the different chips supported -by the -.Nm -driver. Note that wide and twin channel features, although always supported -by a particular chip, may be disabled in a particular motherboard or card -design. -.Pp -.Bd -filled -offset indent -.Bl -column "aic7770 " "10 " "EISA/VL " "10MHz " "16bit " "SCBs " Features -.Em "Chip MIPS Bus MaxSync MaxWidth SCBs Features" -aic7770 10 EISA/VL 10MHz 16Bit 4 1 -aic7850 10 PCI/32 10MHz 8Bit 3 -aic7860 10 PCI/32 20MHz 8Bit 3 -aic7870 10 PCI/32 10MHz 16Bit 16 -aic7880 10 PCI/32 20MHz 16Bit 16 -aic7890 20 PCI/32 40MHz 16Bit 16 3 4 5 6 7 -aic7891 20 PCI/64 40MHz 16Bit 16 3 4 5 6 7 -aic7895 15 PCI/32 20MHz 16Bit 16 2 3 4 5 -aic7896 20 PCI/32 40MHz 16Bit 16 2 3 4 5 6 7 -aic7897 20 PCI/64 40MHz 16Bit 16 2 3 4 5 6 7 -.El -.Pp -.Bl -enum -compact -.It -Multiplexed Twin Channel Device - One controller servicing two busses. -.It -Multi-function Twin Channel Device - Two controllers on one chip. -.It -Command Channel Secondary DMA Engine - Allows scatter gather list and -SCB prefetch. -.It -64 Byte SCB Support - SCSI CDB is embedded in the SCB to eliminate an extra DMA. -.It -Block Move Instruction Support - Doubles the speed of certain sequencer -operations. -.It -.Sq Bayonet -style Scatter Gather Engine - Improves S/G prefetch performance. -.It -Queuing Registers - Allows queuing of new transactions without pausing the -sequencer. -.El -.Ed -.Pp - -.Sh SCSI CONTROL BLOCKS (SCBs) -Every transaction sent to a device on the SCSI bus is assigned a -.Sq SCSI Control Block -(SCB). The SCB contains all of the information required by the -controller to process a transaction. The chip feature table lists -the number of SCBs that can be stored in on chip memory. All chips -with model numbers greater than or equal to 7870 allow for the on chip -SCB space to be augmented with external SRAM up to a maximum of 255 SCBs. -Very few Adaptec controller have external SRAM. - -If external SRAM is not available, SCBs are a limited resource and -using them in a straight forward manner would only allow us to -keep as many transactions as there are SCBs outstanding at a time. -This would not allow enough concurrency to fully utilize the SCSI -bus and it's devices. The solution to this problem is -.Em SCB Paging , -a concept similar to memory paging. SCB paging takes advantage of -the fact that devices usually disconnect from the SCSI bus for long -periods of time without talking to the controller. The SCBs -for disconnected transactions are only of use to the controller -when the transfer is resumed. When the host queues another transaction -for the controller to execute, the controller firmware will use a -free SCB if one is available. Otherwise, the state of the most recently -disconnected (and therefor most likely to stay disconnected) SCB is -saved, via dma, to host memory, and the local SCB reused to start -the new transaction. This allows the controller to queue up to -255 transactions regardless of the amount of SCB space. Since the -local SCB space serves as a cache for disconnected transactions, the -more SCB space available, the less host bus traffic consumed saving -and restoring SCB data. -.Sh BUGS -Some Quantum drives (at least the Empire 2100 and 1080s) will not run on an -.Tn AIC7870 -Rev B in synchronous mode at 10MHz. Controllers with this problem have a -42 MHz clock crystal on them and run slightly above 10MHz. This confuses -the drive and hangs the bus. Setting a maximum synchronous negotiation rate -of 8MHz in the -.Tn SCSI-Select -utility -will allow normal operation. -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr aha 4 , -.Xr ahb 4 , -.Xr cd 4 , -.Xr da 4 , -.Xr sa 4 , -.Xr scsi 4 -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver, the -.Tn AIC7xxx -sequencer-code assembler, -and the firmware running on the aic7xxx chips was written by -.An Justin T. Gibbs . -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -driver appeared in -.Fx 2.0 . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/al.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/al.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 57e86b650b53..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/al.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,152 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998, 1999 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd May 20, 1999 -.Dt AL 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm al -.Nd -ADMtek Inc. AL981 Comet and AN985 Centaur fast ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device al0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI ethernet adapters and embedded -controllers based on the ADMtek Inc. AL981 Comet and AN 985 -Centaur fast ethernet controller chips. -.Pp -The ADMtek chip uses bus master DMA and is designed to be a -DEC 21x4x workalike. The only major difference between the DEC -and ADMtek parts is that the ADMtek receiver filter is programmed -using two special registers where as the DEC chip is programmed -by uploading a special setup frame via the transmit DMA engine. -The AL981 and AN985 can only be programmed with a single -perfect filter entry for the local station address and a 64-bit -multicast hash table; the DEC filter supports several other -options. The ADMtek fast ethernet controllers support both -10 and 100Mbps speeds in either full or half duplex using -an internal MII transceiver. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. -The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -fine. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "ax%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "ax%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "ax%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.It "ax%d: no memory for rx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the receiver ring. -.It "ax%d: no memory for tx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the transmitter ring when -allocating a pad buffer or collapsing an mbuf chain into a cluster. -.It "ax%d: chip is in D3 power state -- setting to D0" -This message applies only to adapters which support power -management. Some operating systems place the controller in low power -mode when shutting down, and some PCI BIOSes fail to bring the chip -out of this state before configuring it. The controller loses all of -its PCI configuration in the D3 state, so if the BIOS does not set -it back to full power mode in time, it won't be able to configure it -correctly. The driver tries to detect this condition and bring -the adapter back to the D0 (full power) state, but this may not be -enough to return the driver to a fully operational condition. If -you see this message at boot time and the driver fails to attach -the device as a network interface, you will have to perform second -warm boot to have the device properly configured. -.Pp -Note that this condition only occurs when warm booting from another -operating system. If you power down your system prior to booting -.Fx , -the card should be configured correctly. -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Rs -.%T ADMtek AL981 data sheet -.%O http://www.admtek.com.tw -.Re -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ctr.columbia.edu . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/atkbd.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/atkbd.4 deleted file mode 100644 index a978c58a028d..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/atkbd.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,208 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1999 -.\" Kazutaka YOKOTA -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer as -.\" the first lines of this file unmodified. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd May 21, 1999 -.Dt ATKBD 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm atkbd -.Nd -the AT keyboard interface -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "options ATKBD_DFLT_KEYMAP" -.Cd "makeoptions ATKBD_DFLT_KEYMAP"=\&"_keymap_name_\&" -.Cd "options KBD_DISABLE_KEYMAP_LOAD" -.Cd "device atkbd0 at atkbdc? irq 1" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver, together with the -.Nm atkbdc -driver, provides access to the AT 84 keyboard or the AT enhanced keyboard -which is connected to the AT keyboard controller. -.Pp -This driver is required for the console drivers -.Xr syscons 4 -and -.Xr pcvt 4 . -.Pp -There can be only one -.Nm -device defined in the kernel configuration file. This device also -requires the -.Nm atkbdc -keyboard controller to be present. -The -.Em irq -number must always be 1; there is no provision of changing the number. -.Ss Function Keys -The AT keyboard has a number of function keys. -They are numbered as follows and can be associated with strings -by the -.Xr kbdcontrol 1 -command. -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width "Function Key Number" -compact -offset -.It "Function Key number" -Function Key -.It "1, 2,...12" -F1, F2,... F12 -.It "13, 14,...24" -Shift+F1, Shift+F2,... Shift+F12 -.It "25, 26,...36" -Ctl+F1, Ctl+F2,... Ctl+F12 -.It "37, 38,...48" -Shift+Ctl+F1, Shift+Ctl+F2,... Shift+Ctl+F12 -.It 49 -Home and Numpad 7 (without NumLock) -.It 50 -Up Arrow and Numpad 8 (without NumLock) -.It 51 -Page Up and Numpad 9 (without NumLock) -.It 52 -Numpad - -.It 53 -Left Arrow and Numpad 4 (without NumLock) -.It 54 -Numpad 5 (without NumLock) -.It 55 -Right Arrow and Numpad 6 (without NumLock) -.It 56 -Numpad + -.It 57 -End and Numpad 1 (without NumLock) -.It 58 -Down Arrow and Numpad 2 (without NumLock) -.It 59 -Page Down and Numpad 3 (without NumLock) -.It 60 -Ins and Numpad 0 (without NumLock) -.It 61 -Del -.It 62 -Left GUI Key -.It 63 -Right GUI Key -.It 64 -Menu -.El -.Pp -See the man page for the -.Xr kbdcontrol 1 -command for how to assign a string to the function key. -.Sh DRIVER CONFIGURATION -.Ss Kernel Configuration Options -The following kernel configuration options control the -.Nm -driver. -.Bl -tag -width ATKBD_DFLT -.It Em ATKBD_DFLT_KEYMAP -This option sets the defauilt, built-in keymap of the -.Nm -driver to the named keymap. -See -.Sx EXAMPLE -below. -.It Em KBD_DISABLE_KEYMAP_LOAD -The keymap can be modified by the -.Xr kbdcontrol 1 -command. -This option will disable this feature and prevent the user from -changing key assignment. -.El -.Pp -.Ss Driver Flags -The -.Nm -driver accepts the following driver flags. They can be set either in the -kernel configuration file -.Pq see Xr config 8 , -or else in the User Configuration Menu at boot time -.Pq see Xr boot 8 . -.Bl -tag -width FAIL -.It bit 0 (FAIL_IF_NO_KBD) -By default the -.Nm -driver will install even if a keyboard is not actually connected to the -system. -This option prevents the driver from being installed in this situation. -.It bit 1 (NO_RESET) -When this option is given, the -.Nm -driver will not reset the keyboard when initializing it. -It may be useful for laptop computers whose function keys -have special functions and these functions are forgotten when the -keyboard is reset. -.It bit 2 (ALT_SCANCODESET) -Certain keyboards, such as those on some ThinkPad models, behave -like the old XT keyboard and require this option. -.El -.\".Sh FILES -.Sh EXAMPLE -The -.Nm -driver requires the keyboard controller -.Nm atkbdc . -Thus, the kernel configuration file should contain the following lines. -.Pp -.Dl "device atkbdc0 at isa" -.Dl "device atkbd0 at atkbdc? irq 1" -.Pp -The following example shows how to set the default, built-in keymap -to -.Pa jp.106.kbd . -.Pp -.Dl "options ATKBD_DFLT_KEYMAP" -.Dl "makeoptions ATKBD_DFLT_KEYMAP"=\&"jp.106\&" -.Dl "device atkbd0 at atkbdc? irq 1" -.Pp -.\".Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.\".Sh CAVEATS -.\".Sh BUGS -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr kbdcontrol 1 , -.Xr atkbdc 4 , -.Xr pcvt 4 , -.Xr psm 4 , -.Xr syscons 4 , -.Xr boot 8 , -.Xr config 8 . -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.1 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Søren Schmidt Aq sos@FreeBSD.org -and -.An Kazutaka Yokota Aq yokota@FreeBSD.org . -This manual page was written by -.An Kazutaka Yokota . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/atkbdc.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/atkbdc.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 794db4ea8ebe..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/atkbdc.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,112 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1999 -.\" Kazutaka YOKOTA -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer as -.\" the first lines of this file unmodified. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd February 9, 1999 -.Dt ATKBDC 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm atkbdc -.Nd -the AT keyboard controller interface -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "options" \&"KBD_RESETDELAY=N\&" -.Cd "options" \&"KBD_MAXWAIT=N\&" -.Cd "options" \&"KBDIO_DEBUG=N\&" -.Cd "controller atkbdc0 at isa? port IO_KBD" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The keyboard controller -.Nm -provides I/O services for the AT keyboard and PS/2 mouse style -pointing devices. -This controller is required for the keyboard driver -.Nm atkbd -and the PS/2 pointing device driver -.Nm psm . -.Pp -There can be only one -.Nm -device configured in the system. -.Sh DRIVER CONFIGURATION -.Ss Kernel Configuration Options -The following kernel configuration options can be used to control the -.Nm -driver. -They may be set in the kernel configuration file -.Pq see Xr config 8 . -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE -.It Em KBD_RESETDELAY=X, KBD_MAXWAIT=Y -The keyboard driver -.Nm atkbd -and the pointing device driver -.Nm psm -may ask the -.Nm -driver to reset these devices during the boot process. -It sometimes takes a long time before these devices respond to -the reset command. -These options control how long the -.Nm -driver should -wait before eventually giving up -- the driver will wait -.Fa X -* -.Fa Y -msecs at most. If the drivers seem unable to detect -devices, you may want to increase these values. The default values are -200 msec for -.Fa X -and 5 -for -.Fa Y . -.It Em KBDIO_DEBUG=N -Sets the debug level to -.Fa N . -The default value is zero, which suppresses all debugging output. -.El -.\".Ss Driver Flags -.\".Sh FILES -.\".Sh EXAMPLE -.\".Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.\".Sh CAVEATS -.\".Sh BUGS -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr atkbd 4 , -.Xr psm 4 , -.Xr config 8 . -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.1 . -It is based on the kbdio module in -.Fx 2.2 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The kbdio module, the -.Nm -driver and this manual page were written by -.An Kazutaka Yokota Aq yokota@FreeBSD.org . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ax.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ax.4 deleted file mode 100644 index be161df44c02..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ax.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,155 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998, 1999 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd January 2, 1999 -.Dt AX 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm ax -.Nd -ASIX Electronics AX88140A and AX88141 fast ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device ax0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI ethernet adapters and embedded -controllers based on the ASIX AX88140A and AX88141 fast ethernet -controller chips, including the Alfa Inc. GFC2204 and the CNet Pro110B. -The AX88141 is a new version of the AX88140A with power management -and magic packet support. -.Pp -The ASIX chip uses bus master DMA and is designed to be a -DEC 21x4x workalike. The only major difference between the DEC -and ASIX parts is that the ASIX receiver filter is programmed -using two special registers where as the DEC chip is programmed -by uploading a special setup frame via the transmit DMA engine. -The ASIX receive filter can only be programmed with a single -perfect filter entry for the local station address and a 64-bit -multicast hash table; the DEC filter supports several other -options. The ASIX fast ethernet controller supports both -10 and 100Mbps speeds in either full or half duplex using -an external MII transceiver. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. -The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -file. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "ax%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "ax%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "ax%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.It "ax%d: no memory for rx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the receiver ring. -.It "ax%d: no memory for tx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the transmitter ring when -allocating a pad buffer or collapsing an mbuf chain into a cluster. -.It "ax%d: chip is in D3 power state -- setting to D0" -This message applies only to adapters which support power -management. Some operating systems place the controller in low power -mode when shutting down, and some PCI BIOSes fail to bring the chip -out of this state before configuring it. The controller loses all of -its PCI configuration in the D3 state, so if the BIOS does not set -it back to full power mode in time, it won't be able to configure it -correctly. The driver tries to detect this condition and bring -the adapter back to the D0 (full power) state, but this may not be -enough to return the driver to a fully operational condition. If -you see this message at boot time and the driver fails to attach -the device as a network interface, you will have to perform second -warm boot to have the device properly configured. -.Pp -Note that this condition only occurs when warm booting from another -operating system. If you power down your system prior to booting -.Fx , -the card should be configured correctly. -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Rs -.%T ASIX AX81140A data sheet -.%O http://www.asix.com.tw -.Re -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ctr.columbia.edu . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/de.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/de.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 938d09fff693..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/de.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,119 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1997 David E. O'Brien -.\" -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE DEVELOPERS ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE DEVELOPERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd January 19, 1997 -.Dt DE 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm de -.Nd -DEC DC21x4x Ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device de0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for the Ethernet adapters based on the Digital -Equipment DC21x4x based self-contained Ethernet chips. -.Pp -It supports the DEC PCI DE435 card, DEC EISA DE425, DEC DE450, DEC DE500, -SMC 8432, 9332 and 9334, Cogent EM100FX and EM440TX, Asante, -ZNYX ZX3xx, and others based on the 21040 and 21041 Ethernet controllers or -the 21140[A], 21141, 21142 and 21143 Fast 100Mbps Ethernet controllers. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation on the 10baseT port -.It 10base2/BNC -Set 10Mbps operation on the BNC port -.It 10base5/AUI -Set 10Mbps operation on the AUI port -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation -.It 100baseFX -Set 100Mbps operation -.It 100baseT4 -Set 100Mbps operation (4-pair cat-3 cable) -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Set full duplex operation -.El -.Pp -Note that the media types available depend on the particular card in use. -Some cards are explicitly programmed to a particular media type by a -setup utility and are not changeable. -.Pp -Use the -.Xr ifconfig 8 -command an in particular the -.Fl m -flag to list the supported media types for your particular card. -.Pp -The old -.Dq ifconfig linkN -method of configuration is not supported. -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "de%d: waking device from sleep/snooze mode" -The 21041 and 21140A chips support suspending the operation of the card. -.It "de%d: error: desired IRQ of %d does not match device's actual IRQ of %d" -The device probe detected that the board is configured for a different -interrupt than the one specified in the kernel configuration file. -.It "de%d: not configured; limit of %d reached or exceeded" -There is a limit of 32 -.Nm -devices allowed in a single machine. -.It "de%d: not configured; 21040 pass 2.0 required (%d.%d found)" -.It "de%d: not configured; 21140 pass 1.1 required (%d.%d found)" -Certain revisions of the chipset are not supported by this driver. -.El -.Sh CAVEATS -Since the 21040 is available on both EISA and PCI boards, one must be careful -in how defines the 21040 in the kernel config file. -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -device driver was written by -.An Matt Thomas . -This manual page was written by -.An David E. O'Brien . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/dm.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/dm.4 deleted file mode 100644 index b095c80b5984..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/dm.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,150 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998, 1999 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd September 4, 1999 -.Dt DM 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm dm -.Nd -Davicom DM9100/DM9102 fast ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "controller miibus0" -.Cd "device dm0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI ethernet adapters and embedded -controllers based on the Davicom DM9100 and DM9102 PCI -fast ethernet controller chips including the Jaton Corporation -XPressNet. -.Pp -The DM9100 and DM9102 are designed to be DEC 21x4x workalikes. The -register layout, DMA descriptor scheme and receive filter programming -are identical to the DEC part. The DM9102 -is a 100Mbps ethernet MAC and MII-compliant transceiver -in a single package. The DM9100 is similar to the DM9102 except -that it has no internal PHY, requiring instead an external transceiver -to be attached to its MII interface. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. -The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -fine. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "dm%d: couldn't map ports/memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "dm%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "dm%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.It "dm%d: no memory for rx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the receiver ring. -.It "dm%d: no memory for tx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the transmitter ring when -allocating a pad buffer or collapsing an mbuf chain into a cludmr. -.It "dm%d: chip is in D3 power state -- setting to D0" -This message applies only to adapters which support power -management. Some operating sydmms place the controller in low power -mode when shutting down, and some PCI BIOSes fail to bring the chip -out of this state before configuring it. The controller loses all of -its PCI configuration in the D3 state, so if the BIOS does not set -it back to full power mode in time, it won't be able to configure it -correctly. The driver tries to detect this condition and bring -the adapter back to the D0 (full power) state, but this may not be -enough to return the driver to a fully operational condition. If -you see this message at boot time and the driver fails to attach -the device as a network interface, you will have to perform second -warm boot to have the device properly configured. -.Pp -Note that this condition only occurs when warm booting from another -operating sydmm. If you power down your sydmm prior to booting -.Fx , -the card should be configured correctly. -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Rs -.%T Davicom DM9102 datasheet -.%O http://www.davicom8.com -.Re -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ee.columbia.edu . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/fdc.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/fdc.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 55ca47bc58e0..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/fdc.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,70 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1994 Wilko Bulte -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products -.\" derived from this software withough specific prior written permission -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd August 31, 1994 -.Dt FDC 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm fdc -.Nd -PC architecture floppy disk controller driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "controller fdc0 at isa? port" \&"IO_FD1\&" "bio flags 0x1 irq 6 drq 2" -.Cd "disk fd0 at fdc0 drive 0 -.Cd "disk fd1 at fdc0 drive 1 -.Sh DESCRIPTION -This driver provides access to floppy disk drives and QIC40/80 tapedrives. -In /dev for each floppy device a number of minor devices are present. The -/dev/fd* devices with trailing alphabetic characters are used to indicate -.Sq partitions -on the floppy disk. The /dev/fd*. are devices that -indicate the size of the floppy disk (so: 720kB, 1440kB etc). The latter -are used for formatting disks using fdformat or for accessing different -density disks in multidensity drive. Example: 720kB disk in a 1.44Mb drive. -.Pp -Normally, the driver will ask the system's CMOS memory to obtain the -floppy drive configuration. Some machines do not store any form of a -configuration value in their CMOS. Use the flags value -.Ql 0x1 -to pretend a 1.44 MB floppy drive as the first unit, without asking the -CMOS for it. -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width Pa -compact -.It /dev/fd* -floppy disk device nodes -.It /dev/fd*. -floppy disk device nodes where the trailing number indicates the floppy -capacity -.It Pa /sys/i386/conf/GENERIC -sample generic kernel config file -.It Pa /sys/i386/isa/fd.c -floppy driver source -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr fdformat 1 , -.Xr disktab 5 diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/fxp.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/fxp.4 deleted file mode 100644 index fcf673cc1fdc..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/fxp.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,96 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1997 David E. O'Brien -.\" -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE DEVELOPERS ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE DEVELOPERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd January 19, 1997 -.Dt FXP 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm fxp -.Nd -Intel EtherExpress Pro/100B ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device fxp0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for the EtherExpress Pro/10, Pro/100B, and Pro/100+ -PCI Fast Ethernet adapters based on the Intel i82557 or i82559 ethernet -chips. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Set full duplex operation -.El -.Pp -Note that 100baseTX media type is only available on the Pro/100B and Pro/100+. -For further information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "fxp%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "fxp%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "fxp%d: Failed to malloc memory" -There are not enough mbuf's available for allocation. -.It "fxp%d: device timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 2.1 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -device driver was written by -.An David Greenman . -This manual page was written by -.An David E. O'Brien . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/keyboard.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/keyboard.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 575936bd1b11..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/keyboard.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,152 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd January 8, 1995 -.Dt KEYBOARD 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm keyboard -.Nd pc keyboard interface -.Sh DESCRIPTION - -The PC keyboard is used as the console character input device. The keyboard -is owned by the current virtual console. -To switch between the virtual consoles use the sequence -.Ar ALT+Fn , -which means hold down ALT and press one of the function keys. The -virtual console with the same number as the function key is then -selected as the current virtual console and given exclusive use of -the keyboard and display. - -The console allows entering values that are not physically -present on the keyboard via a special keysequence. -To use this facility press and hold down ALT, -then enter a decimal number from 0-255 via the numerical keypad, then -release ALT. The entered value is then used as the ASCII value for one -character. This way it is possible to enter any ASCII value, not present -on the keyboard. -The console driver also includes a history function. It is activated by -pressing the scroll-lock key. This holds the display, and enables the cursor -arrows for scrolling up and down through the last scrolled out lines. - -The keyboard is configurable to suit the individual user and the different -national layout. - -The keys on the keyboard can have any of the following functions: - - Normal key - Enter the ASCII value associated with the key. - - Function key - Enter a string of ASCII values. - - Switch Key - Switch virtual console. - - Modifier Key - Change the meaning of another key. - - -The keyboard is seen as a number of keys numbered from 1 to n. This -number is often referred to as the "scancode" for a given key. The number -of the key is transmitted as an 8 bit char with bit 7 as 0 when a key is -pressed, and the number with bit 7 as 1 when released. This makes it -possible to make the mapping of the keys fully configurable. - -The meaning of every key is programmable via the PIO_KEYMAP ioctl call, that -takes a structure keymap_t as argument. The layout of this structure is as -follows: -.Pp -.Bd -literal -offset indent - struct keymap { - u_short n_keys; - struct key_t { - u_char map[NUM_STATES]; - u_char spcl; - u_char flgs; - } key[NUM_KEYS]; - }; -.Ed -.Pp -The field n_keys tells the system how many keydefinitions (scancodes) -follows. Each scancode is then specified in the key_t substructure. - -Each scancode can be translated to any of 8 different values, depending -on the shift, control, and alt state. These eight possibilities are -represented by the map array, as shown below: - - alt - scan cntrl alt alt cntrl - code base shift cntrl shift alt shift cntrl shift - map[n] 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 - ---- ------------------------------------------------------ - 0x1E 'a' 'A' 0x01 0x01 'a' 'A' 0x01 0x01 - -This is the default mapping for the key labelled 'A' which normally has -scancode 0x1E. The eight states are as shown, giving the 'A' key its -normal behavior. -The spcl field is used to give the key "special" treatment, and is -interpreted as follows. -Each bit corresponds to one of the states above. If the bit is 0 the -key emits the number defined in the corresponding map[] entry. -If the bit is 1 the key is "special". This means it does not emit -anything; instead it changes the "state". That means it is a shift, -control, alt, lock, switch-screen, function-key or no-op key. -The bitmap is backwards ie. 7 for base, 6 for shift etc. - -The flgs field defines if the key should react on caps-lock (1), -num-lock (2), both (3) or ignore both (0). - -The -.Xr kbdcontrol 1 -utility is used to load such a description into/outof -the kernel at runtime. This makes it possible to change the key -assignments at runtime, or more important to get (GIO_KEYMAP ioctl) -the exact key meanings from the kernel (fx. used by the X server). - -The function keys can be programmed using the SETFKEY ioctl call. - -This ioctl takes a argument of the type fkeyarg_t: -.Bd -literal -offset indent - struct fkeyarg { - u_short keynum; - char keydef[MAXFK]; - char flen; - }; -.Ed -.Pp -The field keynum defines which function key that is programmed. -The array keydef should contain the new string to be used (MAXFK long), -and the length should be entered in flen. - -The GETFKEY ioctl call works in a similar manner, except it returns -the current setting of keynum. - -The function keys are numbered like this: -.Bd -literal -offset indent - F1-F12 key 1 - 12 - Shift F1-F12 key 13 - 24 - Ctrl F1-F12 key 25 - 36 - Ctrl+shift F1-F12 key 37 - 48 - - Home key 49 - Up arrow key 50 - Page Up key 51 - (keypad) - key 52 - Left arrow key 53 - (keypad) 5 key 54 - Right arrow key 55 - (keypad) + key 56 - End key 57 - Down arrow key 58 - Page down key 59 - Insert key 60 - Delete key 61 - - Right window key 62 - Left window key 63 - Menu key 64 -.Ed - -The -.Xr kbdcontrol 1 -utility also allows changing these values at runtime. -.Pp -.Sh AUTHORS -.An Søren Schmidt Aq sos@FreeBSD.org diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/mem.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/mem.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 58d019cea00a..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/mem.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,193 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1991 The Regents of the University of California. -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by the University of -.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE -.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL -.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS -.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) -.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT -.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY -.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF -.\" SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" @(#)mem.4 5.3 (Berkeley) 5/2/91 -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd May 2, 1991 -.Dt MEM 4 i386 -.Os -.Sh NAME -.Nm mem , -.Nm kmem -.Nd memory files -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The special file -.Nm /dev/mem -is an interface to the physical memory of the computer. -Byte offsets in this file are interpreted as physical memory addresses. -Reading and writing this file is equivalent to reading and writing -memory itself. -Only offsets within the bounds of -.Nm /dev/mem -are allowed. -.Pp -Kernel virtual memory is accessed through the interface -.Nm /dev/kmem -in the same manner as -.Nm /dev/mem . -Only kernel virtual addresses that are currently mapped to memory are allowed. -.Pp -On -.Tn ISA -the -.Tn I/O -memory space begins at physical address 0x000a0000 -and runs to 0x00100000. -The -per-process data -size -for the current process -is -.Dv UPAGES -long, and ends at virtual -address 0xf0000000. -.Sh IOCTL INTERFACE -Several architectures allow attributes to be associated with ranges of physical -memory. These attributes can be manipulated via -.Fn ioctl -calls performed on -.Nm /dev/mem . -Declarations and data types are to be found in -.Pa -.Pp -The specific attributes, and number of programmable ranges may vary between -architectures. The full set of supported attributes is: -.Bl -tag -width 10 -.It MDF_UNCACHEABLE -The region is not cached. -.It MDF_WRITECOMBINE -Writes to the region may be combined or performed out of order. -.It MDF_WRITETHROUGH -Writes to the region are committed synchronously. -.It MDF_WRITEBACK -Writes to the region are committed asynchronously. -.It MDF_WRITEPROTECT -The region cannot be written to. -.El -.Pp -Memory ranges are described by -.Fa struct mem_range_desc : -.Bd -literal -offset indent -u_int64_t mr_base; /\(** physical base address \(**/ -u_int64_t mr_len; /\(** physical length of region \(**/ -int mr_flags; /\(** attributes of region \(**/ -char mr_owner[8]; -.Ed -.Pp -In addition to the region attributes listed above, the following flags -may also be set in the -.Fa mr_flags -field: -.Bl -tag -width 10 -.It MDF_FIXBASE -The region's base address cannot be changed. -.It MDF_FIXLEN -The region's length cannot be changed. -.It MDF_FIRMWARE -The region is believed to have been established by the system firmare. -.It MDF_ACTIVE -The region is currently active. -.It MDF_BOGUS -We believe the region to be invalid or otherwise erroneous. -.It MDF_FIXACTIVE -The region cannot be disabled. -.It MDF_BUSY -The region is currently owned by another process and may not be -altered. -.El -.Pp -Operations are performed using -.Fa struct mem_range_op : -.Bd -literal -offset indent -struct mem_range_desc *mo_desc; -int mo_arg[2]; -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Fa MEMRANGE_GET -ioctl is used to retrieve current memory range attributes. If -.Fa mo_arg[0] -is set to 0, it will be updated with the total number of memory range -descriptors. If greater than 0, the array at -.Fa mo_desc -will be filled with a corresponding number of descriptor structures, -or the maximum, whichever is less. -.Pp -The -.Fa MEMRANGE_SET -ioctl is used to add, alter and remove memory range attributes. A range -with the MDF_FIXACTIVE flag may not be removed; a range with the MDF_BUSY -flag may not be removed or updated. -.Pp -.Fa mo_arg[0] -should be set to MEMRANGE_SET_UPDATE to update an existing -or establish a new range, or to MEMRANGE_SET_REMOVE to remove a range. -.Pp -.Sh RETURN VALUES -.Bl -tag -width 10 -.It EOPNOTSUPP -Memory range operations are not supported on this architecture. -.It ENXIO -No memory range descriptors are available (eg. firmware has not enabled -any). -.It EINVAL -The memory range supplied as an argument is invalid or overlaps another -range in a fashion not supported by this architecture. -.It EBUSY -An attempt to remove or update a range failed because the range is busy. -.It ENOSPC -An attempt to create a new range failed due to a shortage of hardware -resources (eg. descriptor slots). -.It ENOENT -An attempt to remove a range failed because no range matches the descriptor -base/length supplued. -.It EPERM -An attempt to remove a range failed because the range is permanently -enabled. -.El -.Sh BUGS -Busy range attributes are not yet managed correctly. -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width Pa -compact -.It Pa /dev/mem -.It Pa /dev/kmem -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr memcontrol 8 -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm mem , -.Nm kmem -files appeared in -.At v6 . -The ioctl interface for memory range attributes was added in -.Fx 3.2 . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/mouse.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/mouse.4 deleted file mode 100644 index c9db17c79177..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/mouse.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,382 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1997 -.\" Kazutaka YOKOTA -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer as -.\" the first lines of this file unmodified. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd December 3, 1997 -.Dt MOUSE 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm mouse -.Nd mouse and pointing device drivers -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Fd #include -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The mouse drivers -.Xr mse 4 , -.Xr psm 4 -and -.Xr sysmouse 4 -provide user programs with movement and button state information of the mouse. -Currently there are specific device drivers for bus, InPort and PS/2 mice. -The serial mouse is not directly supported by a dedicated driver, but -it is accessible via the serial device driver or via -.Xr moused 8 -and -.Xr sysmouse 4 . -.Pp -The user program simply opens a mouse device with a -.Xr open 2 -call and reads -mouse data from the device via -.Xr read 2 . -Movement and button states are usually encoded in fixed-length data packets. -Some mouse devices may send data in variable length of packets. -Actual protocol (data format) used by each driver differs widely. -.Pp -The mouse drivers may have ``non-blocking'' attribute which will make -the driver return immediately if mouse data is not available. -.Pp -Mouse device drivers often offer several levels of operation. -The current operation level can be examined and changed via -.Xr ioctl 2 -commands. -The level zero is the lowest level at which the driver offers the basic -service to user programs. -Most drivers provide horizontal and vertical movement of the mouse -and state of up to three buttons at this level. -At the level one, if supported by the driver, mouse data is encoded -in the standard format -.Dv MOUSE_PROTO_SYSMOUSE -as follows: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width Byte_1 -compact -.It Byte 1 -.Bl -tag -width bit_7 -compact -.It bit 7 -Always one. -.It bit 6..3 -Always zero. -.It bit 2 -Left button status; cleared if pressed, otherwise set. -.It bit 1 -Middle button status; cleared if pressed, otherwise set. Always one, -if the device does not have the middle button. -.It bit 0 -Right button status; cleared if pressed, otherwise set. -.El -.It Byte 2 -The first half of horizontal movement count in two's complement; --128 through 127. -.It Byte 3 -The first half of vertical movement count in two's complement; --128 through 127. -.It Byte 4 -The second half of the horizontal movement count in two's complement; --128 through 127. To obtain the full horizontal movement count, add -the byte 2 and 4. -.It Byte 5 -The second half of the vertical movement count in two's complement; --128 through 127. To obtain the full vertical movement count, add -the byte 3 and 5. -.It Byte 6 -The bit 7 is always zero. The lower 7 bits encode the first half of -Z axis movement count in two's complement; -64 through 63. -.It Byte 7 -The bit 7 is always zero. The lower 7 bits encode the second half of -the Z axis movement count in two's complement; -64 through 63. -To obtain the full Z axis movement count, add the byte 6 and 7. -.It Byte 8 -The bit 7 is always zero. The bits 0 through 6 reflect the state -of the buttons 4 through 10. -If a button is pressed, the corresponding bit is cleared. Otherwise -the bit is set. -.El -.Pp -The first 5 bytes of this format is compatible with the MouseSystems -format. The additional 3 bytes have their MSBs always set to zero. -Thus, if the user program can interpret the MouseSystems data format and -tries to find the first byte of the format by detecting the bit pattern -10000xxxb, -it will discard the additional bytes, thus, be able to decode x, y -and states of 3 buttons correctly. -.Pp -Device drivers may offer operation levels higher than one. -Refer to manual pages of individual drivers for details. -.Sh IOCTLS -The following -.Xr ioctl 2 -commands are defined for the mouse drivers. The degree of support -varies from one driver to another. This section gives general -description of the commands. -Refer to manual pages of individual drivers for specific details. -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE -compact -.It Dv MOUSE_GETLEVEL Ar int *level -.It Dv MOUSE_SETLEVEL Ar int *level -These commands manipulate the operation level of the mouse driver. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_GETHWINFO Ar mousehw_t *hw -Returns the hardware information of the attached device in the following -Except for the -.Dv iftype -field, the device driver may not always fill the structure with correct -values. -Consult manual pages of individual drivers for details of support. -.Bd -literal -typedef struct mousehw { - int buttons; /* number of buttons */ - int iftype; /* I/F type */ - int type; /* mouse/track ball/pad... */ - int model; /* I/F dependent model ID */ - int hwid; /* I/F dependent hardware ID */ -} mousehw_t; -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Dv buttons -field holds the number of buttons detected by the driver. The driver -may put an arbitrary value, such as two, in this field, if it cannot -determine the exact number. -.Pp -The -.Dv iftype -is the type of interface: -.Dv MOUSE_IF_SERIAL , -.Dv MOUSE_IF_BUS , -.Dv MOUSE_IF_INPORT , -.Dv MOUSE_IF_PS2 , -.Dv MOUSE_IF_SYSMOUSE -or -.Dv MOUSE_IF_UNKNOWN . -.Pp -The -.Dv type -tells the device type: -.Dv MOUSE_MOUSE , -.Dv MOUSE_TRACKBALL , -.Dv MOUSE_STICK , -.Dv MOUSE_PAD , -or -.Dv MOUSE_UNKNOWN . -.Pp -The -.Dv model -may be -.Dv MOUSE_MODEL_GENERIC -or one of -.Dv MOUSE_MODEL_XXX -constants. -.Pp -The -.Dv hwid -is the ID value returned by the pointing device. It -depend on the interface type; refer to the manual page of -specific mouse drivers for possible values. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_GETMODE Ar mousemode_t *mode -The command reports the current operation parameters of the mouse driver. -.Bd -literal -typedef struct mousemode { - int protocol; /* MOUSE_PROTO_XXX */ - int rate; /* report rate (per sec) */ - int resolution; /* MOUSE_RES_XXX, -1 if unknown */ - int accelfactor; /* acceleration factor */ - int level; /* driver operation level */ - int packetsize; /* the length of the data packet */ - unsigned char syncmask[2]; /* sync. bits */ -} mousemode_t; -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Dv protocol -field tells the format in which the device status is returned -when the mouse data is read by the user program. -It is one of -.Dv MOUSE_PROTO_XXX -constants. -.Pp -The -.Dv rate -field is the status report rate (reports/sec) at which the device will send -movement reports to the host computer. -1 if unknown or not applicable. -.Pp -The -.Dv resolution -field holds a value specifying resolution of the pointing device. -It is a positive value or one of -.Dv MOUSE_RES_XXX -constants. -.Pp -The -.Dv accelfactor -field holds a value to control acceleration feature. -It must be zero or greater. -If it is zero, acceleration is disabled. -.Pp -The -.Dv packetsize -field tells the length of the fixed-size data packet or the length -of the fixed part of the variable-length packet. -The size depends on the interface type, the device type and model, the -protocol and the operation level of the driver. -.Pp -The array -.Dv syncmask -holds a bit mask and pattern to detect the first byte of the -data packet. -.Dv syncmask[0] -is the bit mask to be ANDed with a byte. If the result is equal to -.Dv syncmask[1] , -the byte is likely to be the first byte of the data packet. -Note that this method of detecting the first byte is not 100% reliable, -thus, should be taken only as an advisory measure. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_SETMODE Ar mousemode_t *mode -The command changes the current operation parameters of the mouse driver -as specified in -.Ar mode . -Only -.Dv rate , -.Dv resolution , -.Dv level -and -.Dv accelfactor -may be modifiable. Setting values in the other field does not generate -error and has no effect. -.Pp -If you do not want to change the current setting of a field, put -1 -there. -You may also put zero in -.Dv resolution -and -.Dv rate , -and the default value for the fields will be selected. -.\" .Pp -.\" .It Dv MOUSE_GETVARS Ar mousevar_t *vars -.\" Get internal variables of the mouse driver. -.\" The variables which can be manipulated through these commands -.\" are specific to each driver. -.\" This command may not be supported by all drivers. -.\" .Bd -literal -.\" typedef struct mousevar { -.\" int var[16]; /* internal variables */ -.\" } mousevar_t; -.\" .Ed -.\" .Pp -.\" If the commands are supported, the first element of the array is -.\" filled with a signature value. -.\" Apart from the signature data, there is currently no standard concerning -.\" the other elements of the buffer. -.\" .Pp -.\" .It Dv MOUSE_SETVARS Ar mousevar_t *vars -.\" Get internal variables of the mouse driver. -.\" The first element of the array must be a signature value. -.\" This command may not be supported by all drivers. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_READDATA Ar mousedata_t *data -The command reads the raw data from the device. -.Bd -literal -typedef struct mousedata { - int len; /* # of data in the buffer */ - int buf[16]; /* data buffer */ -} mousedata_t; -.Ed -.Pp -The calling process must fill the -.Dv len -field with the number of bytes to be read into the buffer. -This command may not be supported by all drivers. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_READSTATE Ar mousedata_t *state -The command reads the raw state data from the device. -It uses the same structure as above. -This command may not be supported by all drivers. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_GETSTATUS Ar mousestatus_t *status -The command returns the current state of buttons and -movement counts in the following structure. -.Bd -literal -typedef struct mousestatus { - int flags; /* state change flags */ - int button; /* button status */ - int obutton; /* previous button status */ - int dx; /* x movement */ - int dy; /* y movement */ - int dz; /* z movement */ -} mousestatus_t; -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Dv button -and -.Dv obutton -fields hold the current and the previous state of the mouse buttons. -When a button is pressed, the corresponding bit is set. -The mouse drivers may support up to 31 buttons with the bit 0 through 31. -Few button bits are defined as -.Dv MOUSE_BUTTON1DOWN -through -.Dv MOUSE_BUTTON8DOWN . -The first three buttons correspond to left, middle and right buttons. -.Pp -If the state of the button has changed since the last -.Dv MOUSE_GETSTATUS -call, the corresponding bit in the -.Dv flags -field will be set. -If the mouse has moved since the last call, the -.Dv MOUSE_POSCHANGED -bit in the -.Dv flags -field will also be set. -.Pp -The other fields hold movement counts since the last -.Dv MOUSE_GETSTATUS -call. The internal counters will be reset after every call to this -command. -.El -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width /dev/sysmouseXX -compact -.It Pa /dev/cuaa%d -serial ports -.It Pa /dev/mse%d -bus and InPort mouse device -.It Pa /dev/psm%d -PS/2 mouse device -.It Pa /dev/sysmouse -virtual mouse device -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr ioctl 2 , -.Xr mse 4 , -.Xr psm 4 , -.Xr sysmouse 4 , -.Xr moused 8 -.\".Sh HISTORY -.Sh AUTHORS -This manual page was written by -.An Kazutaka Yokota Aq yokota@FreeBSD.org . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/mtio.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/mtio.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 2c8f795b0393..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/mtio.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,299 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1996 -.\" Mike Pritchard . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1983, 1991, 1993 -.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by the University of -.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE -.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL -.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS -.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) -.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT -.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY -.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF -.\" SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" @(#)mtio.4 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/5/93 -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd February 11, 1996 -.Dt MTIO 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD 2.2 -.Sh NAME -.Nm mtio -.Nd -.Tn FreeBSD -magtape interface -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The special files -named -.Pa /dev/[nr]sa* -refer to SCSI tape drives, -which may be attached to the system. -.Pa /dev/[nr]sa*.ctl -are control devices that can be used to issue ioctls to the SCSI -tape driver to set parameters that are required to last beyond the -unmounting of a tape. -.Pp -.Pp -The rewind devices automatically rewind -when the last requested read, write or seek has finished, or the end of the tape -has been reached. The letter -.Ql n -is usually prepended to -the name of the no-rewind devices. -.Pp -Tapes can be written with either fixed length records or variable length -records. See -.Xr sa 4 -for more information. Two end-of-file markers mark the end of a tape, and -one end-of-file marker marks the end of a tape file. -If the tape is not to be rewound it is positioned with the -head in between the two tape marks, where the next write -will over write the second end-of-file marker. -.Pp -All of the magtape devices may be manipulated with the -.Xr mt 1 -command. -.Pp -A number of -.Xr ioctl 2 -operations are available -on raw magnetic tape. -The following definitions are from -.Aq Pa sys/mtio.h : -.Bd -literal -/* - * Structures and definitions for mag tape io control commands - */ - -/* structure for MTIOCTOP - mag tape op command */ -struct mtop { - short mt_op; /* operations defined below */ - daddr_t mt_count; /* how many of them */ -}; - -/* operations */ -#define MTWEOF 0 /* write an end-of-file record */ -#define MTFSF 1 /* forward space file */ -#define MTBSF 2 /* backward space file */ -#define MTFSR 3 /* forward space record */ -#define MTBSR 4 /* backward space record */ -#define MTREW 5 /* rewind */ -#define MTOFFL 6 /* rewind and put the drive offline */ -#define MTNOP 7 /* no operation, sets status only */ -#define MTCACHE 8 /* enable controller cache */ -#define MTNOCACHE 9 /* disable controller cache */ - -#if defined(__FreeBSD__) -/* Set block size for device. If device is a variable size dev */ -/* a non zero parameter will change the device to a fixed block size */ -/* device with block size set to that of the parameter passed in. */ -/* Resetting the block size to 0 will restore the device to a variable */ -/* block size device. */ - -#define MTSETBSIZ 10 - -/* Set density values for device. They are defined in the SCSI II spec */ -/* and range from 0 to 0x17. Sets the value for the opened mode only */ - -#define MTSETDNSTY 11 - -#define MTERASE 12 /* erase to EOM */ -#define MTEOD 13 /* Space to EOM */ -#define MTCOMP 14 /* select compression mode 0=off, 1=def */ -#define MTRETENS 15 /* re-tension tape */ -#define MTWSS 16 /* write setmark(s) */ -#define MTFSS 17 /* forward space setmark */ -#define MTBSS 18 /* backward space setmark */ - -#define MT_COMP_ENABLE 0xffffffff -#define MT_COMP_DISABLED 0xfffffffe -#define MT_COMP_UNSUPP 0xfffffffd - -/* - * Values in mt_dsreg that say what the device is doing - */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_NIL 0 /* Unknown */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_REST 1 /* Doing Nothing */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_RBSY 2 /* Communicating with tape (but no motion) */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_WR 20 /* Writing */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_FMK 21 /* Writing Filemarks */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_ZER 22 /* Erasing */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_RD 30 /* Reading */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_FWD 40 /* Spacing Forward */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_REV 41 /* Spacing Reverse */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_POS 42 /* Hardware Positioning (direction unknown) */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_REW 43 /* Rewinding */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_TEN 44 /* Retensioning */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_UNL 45 /* Unloading */ -#define MTIO_DSREG_LD 46 /* Unloading */ - -#endif - -/* structure for MTIOCGET - mag tape get status command */ - -struct mtget { - short mt_type; /* type of magtape device */ -/* the following two registers are grossly device dependent */ - short mt_dsreg; /* ``drive status'' register */ - short mt_erreg; /* ``error'' register */ -/* end device-dependent registers */ - short mt_resid; /* residual count */ -#if defined (__FreeBSD__) - daddr_t mt_blksiz; /* presently operating blocksize */ - daddr_t mt_density; /* presently operating density */ - daddr_t mt_comp; /* presently operating compression */ - daddr_t mt_blksiz0; /* blocksize for mode 0 */ - daddr_t mt_blksiz1; /* blocksize for mode 1 */ - daddr_t mt_blksiz2; /* blocksize for mode 2 */ - daddr_t mt_blksiz3; /* blocksize for mode 3 */ - daddr_t mt_density0; /* density for mode 0 */ - daddr_t mt_density1; /* density for mode 1 */ - daddr_t mt_density2; /* density for mode 2 */ - daddr_t mt_density3; /* density for mode 3 */ -/* the following are not yet implemented */ - u_char mt_comp0; /* compression type for mode 0 */ - u_char mt_comp1; /* compression type for mode 1 */ - u_char mt_comp2; /* compression type for mode 2 */ - u_char mt_comp3; /* compression type for mode 3 */ -/* end not yet implemented */ -#endif - daddr_t mt_fileno; /* file number of current position */ - daddr_t mt_blkno; /* block number of current position */ -}; - -/* structure for MTIOCERRSTAT - tape get error status command */ -/* really only supported for SCSI tapes right now */ -struct scsi_tape_errors { - /* - * These are latched from the last command that had a SCSI - * Check Condition noted for these operations. The act - * of issuing an MTIOCERRSTAT unlatches and clears them. - */ - u_int8_t io_sense[32]; /* Last Sense Data For Data I/O */ - u_int32_t io_resid; /* residual count from last Data I/O */ - u_int8_t io_cdb[16]; /* Command that Caused the Last Data Sense */ - u_int8_t ctl_sense[32]; /* Last Sense Data For Control I/O */ - u_int32_t ctl_resid; /* residual count from last Control I/O */ - u_int8_t ctl_cdb[16]; /* Command that Caused the Last Control Sense */ - /* - * These are the read and write cumulative error counters. - * (how to reset cumulative error counters is not yet defined). - * (not implemented as yet but space is being reserved for them) - */ - struct { - u_int32_t retries; /* total # retries performed */ - u_int32_t corrected; /* total # corrections performed */ - u_int32_t processed; /* total # corrections succssful */ - u_int32_t failures; /* total # corrections/retries failed */ - u_int64_t nbytes; /* total # bytes processed */ - } wterr, rderr; -}; - -union mterrstat { - struct scsi_tape_errors scsi_errstat; - char _reserved_padding[256]; -}; -/* - * Constants for mt_type byte. These are the same - * for controllers compatible with the types listed. - */ -#define MT_ISTS 0x01 /* TS-11 */ -#define MT_ISHT 0x02 /* TM03 Massbus: TE16, TU45, TU77 */ -#define MT_ISTM 0x03 /* TM11/TE10 Unibus */ -#define MT_ISMT 0x04 /* TM78/TU78 Massbus */ -#define MT_ISUT 0x05 /* SI TU-45 emulation on Unibus */ -#define MT_ISCPC 0x06 /* SUN */ -#define MT_ISAR 0x07 /* SUN */ -#define MT_ISTMSCP 0x08 /* DEC TMSCP protocol (TU81, TK50) */ -#define MT_ISCY 0x09 /* CCI Cipher */ -#define MT_ISCT 0x0a /* HP 1/4 tape */ -#define MT_ISFHP 0x0b /* HP 7980 1/2 tape */ -#define MT_ISEXABYTE 0x0c /* Exabyte */ -#define MT_ISEXA8200 0x0c /* Exabyte EXB-8200 */ -#define MT_ISEXA8500 0x0d /* Exabyte EXB-8500 */ -#define MT_ISVIPER1 0x0e /* Archive Viper-150 */ -#define MT_ISPYTHON 0x0f /* Archive Python (DAT) */ -#define MT_ISHPDAT 0x10 /* HP 35450A DAT drive */ -#define MT_ISMFOUR 0x11 /* M4 Data 1/2 9track drive */ -#define MT_ISTK50 0x12 /* DEC SCSI TK50 */ -#define MT_ISMT02 0x13 /* Emulex MT02 SCSI tape controller */ - -/* mag tape io control commands */ -#define MTIOCTOP _IOW('m', 1, struct mtop) /* do a mag tape op */ -#define MTIOCGET _IOR('m', 2, struct mtget) /* get tape status */ -/* these two do not appear to be used anywhere */ -#define MTIOCIEOT _IO('m', 3) /* ignore EOT error */ -#define MTIOCEEOT _IO('m', 4) /* enable EOT error */ -/* - * When more SCSI-3 SSC (streaming device) devices are out there - * that support the full 32 byte type 2 structure, we'll have to - * rethink these ioctls to support all the entities they haul into - * the picture (64 bit blocks, logical file record numbers, etc..). - */ -#define MTIOCRDSPOS _IOR('m', 5, u_int32_t) /* get logical blk addr */ -#define MTIOCRDHPOS _IOR('m', 6, u_int32_t) /* get hardware blk addr */ -#define MTIOCSLOCATE _IOW('m', 5, u_int32_t) /* seek to logical blk addr */ -#define MTIOCHLOCATE _IOW('m', 6, u_int32_t) /* seek to hardware blk addr */ -#define MTIOCERRSTAT _IOR('m', 7, union mterrstat) /* get tape errors */ - -#ifndef KERNEL -#define DEFTAPE "/dev/nrsa0" -#endif - -#ifdef KERNEL -/* - * minor device number - */ - -#define T_UNIT 003 /* unit selection */ -#define T_NOREWIND 004 /* no rewind on close */ -#define T_DENSEL 030 /* density select */ -#define T_800BPI 000 /* select 800 bpi */ -#define T_1600BPI 010 /* select 1600 bpi */ -#define T_6250BPI 020 /* select 6250 bpi */ -#define T_BADBPI 030 /* undefined selection */ -#endif -#endif /* _SYS_MTIO_H_ */ -.Ed -.Pp -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width /dev/[nr]sa* -compact -.It Pa /dev/[nr]sa* -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr mt 1 , -.Xr tar 1 , -.Xr st 4 -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm mtio -manual appeared in -.Bx 4.2 . -An i386 version first appeared in -.Fx 2.2 . -.Sh BUGS -The status should be returned in a device independent format. -.Pp -The special file naming should be redone in a more consistent and -understandable manner. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/mx.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/mx.4 deleted file mode 100644 index ada9d487ec37..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/mx.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,173 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd November 5, 1998 -.Dt MX 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm mx -.Nd -Macronix 98713/98715/98725 fast ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "controller miibus0" -.Cd "device mx0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI ethernet adapters and embedded -controllers based on the Macronix 98713, 98713A, 98715, 98715A and -98725 fast ethernet controller chips. This includes the NDC -Communications SOHOware SFA110, the SVEC PN102-TX -fast ethernet card, and various other adapters. The -.Nm -driver also supports the Lite-On 82c115 PNIC II chip, which is -actually similar in design to the Macronix 98715A with the addition -of wake on LAN support. Supported PNIC II cards include the -LinkSys LNE100TX Version 2. -.Pp -The Macronix chips use bus master DMA and are designed to be -DEC 'tulip' workalikes. The original 98713 had an MII bus for -controlling an external PHY, however the 98713A and up use an -internal transceiver with NWAY support. The Macronix parts are -advertised as being register compatible with the DEC 21x4x -controllers. All of the Macronix controllers support both -10 and 100Mbps speeds in either full or half duplex. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. -The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -file. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -Note that the 100baseTX media type is only available if supported -by the adapter. -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "mx%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "mx%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "mx%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.It "mx%d: no memory for rx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the receiver ring. -.It "mx%d: no memory for tx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the transmitter ring when -allocating a pad buffer or collapsing an mbuf chain into a cluster. -.It "mx%d: chip is in D3 power state -- setting to D0" -This message applies only to adapters which support power -management. Some operating systems place the controller in low power -mode when shutting down, and some PCI BIOSes fail to bring the chip -out of this state before configuring it. The controller loses all of -its PCI configuration in the D3 state, so if the BIOS does not set -it back to full power mode in time, it won't be able to configure it -correctly. The driver tries to detect this condition and bring -the adapter back to the D0 (full power) state, but this may not be -enough to return the driver to a fully operational condition. If -you see this message at boot time and the driver fails to attach -the device as a network interface, you will have to perform second -warm boot to have the device properly configured. -.Pp -Note that this condition only occurs when warm booting from another -operating system. If you power down your system prior to booting -.Fx , -the card should be configured correctly. -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Rs -.%T Macronix 98713/A, 98715/A and 98725 data sheets -.%O http://www.macronix.com -.Re -.Rs -.%T Macronix 98713/A and 98715/A app notes -.%O http://www.macronix.com -.Re -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ctr.columbia.edu . -.Sh BUGS -The Macronix application notes claim that in order to put the -chips in normal operation, the driver must write a certian magic -number into the CSR16 register. The numbers are documented in -the app notes, but the exact meaning of the bits is not. -.Pp -The 98713A seems to have a problem with 10Mbps full duplex mode. -The transmitter works but the receiver tends to produce many -unexplained errors leading to very poor overall performance. The -98715A does not exhibit this problem. All other modes on the -98713A seem to work correctly. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ncr.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ncr.4 deleted file mode 100644 index ea076c5519e3..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ncr.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,46 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1994 James A. Jegers -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products -.\" derived from this software without specific prior written permission -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd July 10, 1996 -.Dt NCR 4 i386 -.Os -.Sh NAME -.Nm ncr -.Nd NCR 53C8xx SCSI driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device ncr0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for the NCR/Symbios 53C810, 53C810a, -53C815, 53C820, 53C825a, 53C860, 53C875, 53C875j, 53C885, -53C895 and 53C896 SCSI controller chips. -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr cd 4 , -.Xr ch 4 , -.Xr da 4 , -.Xr intro 4 , -.Xr sa 4 , -.Xr scsi 4 diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ohci.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ohci.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 41f875495ff2..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ohci.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,70 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1999 -.\" Nick Hibma . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY NICK HIBMA AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL NICK HIBMA OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd February 21, 1999 -.Dt 0HCI 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm ohci -.Nd -OHCI USB Host Controller Driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "controller ohci0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for OHCI-type PCI based USB controllers. This -includes -.Bl -tag -width xxxxx -.It AcerLabs M5237 (Aladdin-V) -.It OPTi 82C861 (FireLink) -.It NEC uPD 9210 -.It CMD Tech 670 (USB0670) -.It CMD Tech 673 (USB0673) -.El - -or any other OHCI v1.0 compliant controller. -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr uhci 4 -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Lennart Augustsson Aq augustss@carlstedt.se -for the -.Nx -project. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/pcm.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/pcm.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 0478e350a55f..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/pcm.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,202 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1998, Luigi Rizzo -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE -.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL -.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS -.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) -.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT -.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY -.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF -.\" SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd June 3, 1998 -.Dt PCM 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm pcm -.Nd FreeBSD audio device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device pcm0 at isa? port? irq 5 drq 1 flags 0x15" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm pcm -driver provides support for various ISA sound cards that are compatible -with the WSS/MSS specs, or with the SBPro and SB16. Only audio -capture/playback is supported by the driver, and true full duplex -operation is available on most cards. -.Pp -Apart from the usual parameters, the flags field is used to specify -the secondary DMA channel (generally used for capture in full duplex -cards). Flags are set to 0 for cards not using a secondary DMA -channel, or to 0x10 + C to specify channel C. -.Pp -PnP audio cards are also supported using the -.Nm pnp -support which is available in FreeBSD starting from release 2.2.6. -See the -.Xr pnp 4 -manpage for more information. In particular, remember that unit -numbers for (recognized) -PnP cards are assigned after the legacy ISA devices, and that the -actual resources (port, irq and drq) used by the driver are read from -the PnP configuration and not from the "device pcm0" line. -So, if you have the following line in your kernel config file: -.Pp -.Cd "device pcm0 ..." -.Pp -your first PnP audio card will be unit #1, i.e. it will be accessible -as /dev/audio1, /dev/dsp1, etc. -Many applications default to using /dev/audio, but appropriate -symlinks will be created as a side-effect of the the following command: -.Pp -.Cd cd /dev -.Cd ./MAKEDEV snd1 -.Pp -The driver works best with WSS/MSS cards, which have a very clean -architecture and an orthogonal set of features. They also happen to be -among the cheapest audio cards on the market. -Other cards such as SB and ESS have a more complex internal -architecture, and often no documentation available. As a consequence, -support for these cards is slightly worse. -.Pp -The driver does its best to recognize the installed harware and drive -it correctly, so that you don't have to give too many details in the -kernel config files. For PnP cards this is actually easy since they -identify themselves. For legacy ISA cards, the driver first looks for -MSS cards at addresses 0x530 and 0x604, then for SB -cards at 0x220 and 0x240 (obviously, unless overridden in the kernel -config file by specifying an address). - -.Sh IOCTL -The driver supports most of the Voxware ioctls(), and most -applications work unmodified (including popular mpeg players and linux -binaries). A few -differences exist (the most important one is the ability to use -memory-mapped access to the audio buffers). As a consequence, some -applications may need to be recompiled with a slightly modified -audio module. See /usr/include/machine/soundcard.h for a complete -list of the supported ioctls. - -.Sh SUPPORTED CARDS -.Pp -Below we include a list of supported codecs/cards, including, if -possible, the pnp configuration information where applicable -(we give default parameters, your actual resources may vary). - -.Bl -tag -width 2m % begin list -.It CS4237, CS4236, CS4232, CS4231 -.Cd "pnp 1 0 os enable port0 0x534 port2 0x220 irq0 5 drq0 1 drq1 3" -.Pp -All these cards work perfectly in full duplex using the MSS mode. -This chipset is used, among others, on the A/Open AW35 and AW32, on -some Intel motherboards, and (the CS4231) on some non-PnP cards. -.Pp -The CS4232 is reported as buggy in the Voxware documentation but -I am not sure if this is true. On one of my Intel motherboards, -capture does not work simply because the capture DMA channel is -not wired to the ISA DMA controller. - -.It GUSPnP -.Cd "pnp 1 0 os enable port0 0x220 port1 0x320 port2 0x32c irq0 5 drq0 7 drq1 5" -.Pp -Supported in full duplex using the MSS mode. The GUSPnP does not use a -real CS4231, and I suspect a bug in the emulation when operating -with mu-law format. Since the card is discontinued, I did not bother -to include special code to set the card in "Mode3" (where mu-law is -known to work) and rather I use U8 format internally, and do the -conversion in software within the driver. This loses resolution, -so you should use 16-bit modes with this card when possible. - -.It Yamaha OPL-SAx -.Cd "pnp 1 0 os enable port0 0x220 port1 0x530 port2 0x388 port3 0x370 irq0 5 drq0 1 drq1 3" -.Pp -Works perfectly in all modes. This chip is used in several PnP cards, -but also (in non-PnP mode) on motherboards and laptops (e.g. the -Toshiba Libretto). - -.It OPTi931 -.Cd "pnp 1 1 os enable port0 0x534 port2 0x220 port3 0xe0d irq0 10 drq0 1 drq1 6" -.Pp -The chip is buggy, but the driver has many workarounds to make it work -in full duplex because for some time these were the only full duplex -cards I could find. u-law formats uses U8 format internally because of -a bug in the chip. - -.It SB16, Vibra16C, and old SB16/AWExx cards -.Cd "pnp 1 0 os enable port0 0x220 irq0 5 drq0 1 drq1 5" -.Pp -These codecs have limited full duplex capabilities, by doing 8-bit -in one direction and 16-bit in the other one. The driver supports this -mode of operation but keep in mind that it is not a supported mode of -operation from CreativeLabs. - -.It Vibra16X and newer SB16/AWExx cards -.Cd "pnp 1 0 os enable port0 0x220 irq0 5 drq0 1 drq1 3" -.Pp -Recently CreativeLabs has changed the codec (DSP) and the new one is -somewhat different from the old one. The most apparent difference is -the use of two 8-bit DMA channels, which seems to have broken our full -duplex support. Maybe one can achieve full duplex by making use of the -wavetable to play audio, but since this driver does not support the -wavetable you have to stick with half duplex. - -.It SBPro and clones -This is the default mode of operation for most other cards. We have -only limited (and possibly buggy) support for them: 8-bit, half -duplex, even if the hardware in some cases (e.g. ESS chips) might do more. -.El -.Pp -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS AND TROUBLESHOOTING -.Bl -tag -width 2m -.It "This is XXX but LDN Y is disabled" -.Pp -This means that the bios has left the PnP device disabled, and you -have to enable it manually booting with "-c" and giving the pnp -configuration shown above. -.It "pcmX: unit not configured, perhaps you want pcmY ?" -This means that you are using the wrong unit. Generally this happens -when you are using a PnP card without creating the symlinks to the -correct unit. Re-create the symlinks (and possibly also the device -entries) in the /dev directory to point to the right one. - -.It "timeout flushing dbuf_out ..." -This means a problem in the configuration of the card (specifically, -in the DMA channel) or (much less likely) in the driver, which has -not recognized the card correctly. Check the DMA channel used for -capture. - -.It capture does not work -This usually happens when the input dma channel is misconfigured. - -.El -.Sh BUGS -Due to lack of documentation, -SB16 support is not very good. Also, mixer support is not complete, -and some features of your cards (e.g. global volume control) might not -be supported on all devices. -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm pcm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 2.2.6 -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -device driver and this manual page were written by -.An Luigi Rizzo Aq luigi@iet.unipi.it diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/pcvt.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/pcvt.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 31594151dcad..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/pcvt.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,917 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1992, 1995 Hellmuth Michaelis, Brian Dunford-Shore, -.\" Joerg Wunsch and Holger Veit. -.\" -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Hellmuth Michaelis, -.\" Brian Dunford-Shore, Joerg Wunsch and Holger Veit. -.\" 4. The name authors may not be used to endorse or promote products -.\" derived from this software without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHORS ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" @(#)pcvt.4, 3.20, Last Edit-Date: [Sun Apr 2 18:23:39 1995] -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.\" Man page pcvt(4) created after pcvt_ioctl.h on 13-Jan-93 -.\" by Joerg Wunsch -.\" -.\" updated for rel 2.10 (-hm) -.\" updated for rel 2.20 (-hm) -.\" updated for rel 3.00 (-jw) -.\" updated for final rel 3.00 (-hm) -.\" removed references to 386BSD (-hm) -.\" -.Dd February 27, 1994 -.Dt PCVT 4 i386 -.Sh NAME -.Nm pcvt , -.Nm vt -.Nd PC console virtual screen system -.Sh SYNOPSIS -options -.Do -.Em PCVT_FREEBSD = version -| -.Em PCVT_NETBSD = version -.Dc -.br -.Op options Dq Em PCVT_NSCREENS = number -.br -.Op options Dq Em PCVT_XXXX -.Po -see -.Sx Configuration -below -.Pc -.Pp -.Cd "device vt0 at isa?" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -.Ss Overview -The -.Nm pcvt -driver provides a virtual screen system with several additional -features not available in historic console drivers. -Besides the ability of handling -multiple virtual screens, -the probably most important is an emulation of a wide range -of DEC VT-220 -.if t \(tm -.if n (TM) -functionality. See -.Sx Features -for a detailed description. -.Pp -The -.Nm pcvt -driver requires the keyboard driver -.Nm atkbd -to be also configured in the kernel. - -.Ss Features -.Bl -bullet -.It -Almost full DEC VT220 -.if t \(tm -.if n (TM) -functionality -.Po -moving towards VT320 -.if t \(tm -.if n (TM) -.Pc -.It -Completely independent virtual terminals for MDA/HGC/CGA/EGA and VGA -.It -25, 28, 35, 40, 43 or 50x80 screen resolution for each virtual screen -.It -Fully remappable keyboard to support national keyboards -.It -All VT220 character sets plus ISO Latin-1 and DEC technical supported -.It -VT220 downloadable character set supported when run on EGA/VGA -.It -VT220 user defined keys for each virtual terminal -.It -Optional function key label support -.if t \('a -.if n 'a -la Hewlett-Packard -.It -Display function codes functionality -.It -Support for MDA, CGA, EGA and VGA display adaptors -.It -Support for 132 column operation on VGA chipsets -.It -X Window Support for XFree86 >= 1.2 using the pccons model, or -for XFree86 >= 2.0 using the syscons model -.Po -requires -.Em PCVT_USL_VT_COMPAT -to be configured -.Pc -.El - -What it cannot: -.Bl -bullet -.It -No double wide/high characters -.It -No softscroll -.It -No inverse background -.It -No VT220 printer output support -.It -No VT52 support at all -.It -No 8-bit controls -.It -Only limited AT-keyboard -.Pq 84 keys -support -.Pq yet -.It -Help you to make money... -.El - -.Ss Configuration -The -.Nm pcvt -console driver is currently available for the Intel-based BSD operating -systems -.Tn NetBSD/i386 -(release 0.9 or higher), -and -.Tn FreeBSD -(release 1.0-GAMMA or higher) . -In order to get the appropriate system support, one of the options -.Em PCVT_NETBSD , -or -.Em PCVT_FREEBSD -must be defined in the system's config file -.Pq see Xr config 8 . -In addition, for the -.Tn FreeBSD -and -.Tn NetBSD -operating systems, it is necessary to set this option to the operating -system's version number. -For -.Tn FreeBSD -this version number must be expressed as a 3-digit number. -E.\& g., if you are running the 1.0 release -.Pq which is actually version 1.0.2 , -you should define - -.Em PCVT_FREEBSD = 102 - -For -.Em NetBSD -this version number must be expressed as 9 if you are running NetBSD 0.9 -and anything greater than 9 for NetBSD-current (pre 1.0). It is recommended -to use (as with -.Tn FreeBSD ) -100 for -.Nx 1.0 -and 999 for -.Tn NetBSD-current. -E.g., if you are running the -.Nx 1.0 -release, you should define - -.Em PCVT_NETBSD = 100 - -The -.Nm pcvt -driver has been designed to be highly configurable in order to satisfy -everyone's needs. The preferred way for those configurations is to -provide appropriate -.Em options -lines within the config file, possibly overriding the built-in default -values. Therefore it is possible to compile several distinct kernels -with different driver behaviour on a single machine. - -The following list gives a short overview of the available configuration -options. Refer to the file -.Pa i386/isa/pcvt/pcvt_hdr.h -in the kernel source tree for detailed documentation. - -Note: the following conventions apply to all the Boolean options. -If an option is given with no value, a value of 1 -.Pq activated -is substituted. If an option value is given as 0, this options is -deactivated. Any other value is substituted by 1, too. If an option -is omitted, a built-in default is assumed. - -.Bl -tag -width indent -compact - -.It Em PCVT_NSCREENS -Defines the number of virtual screens. -.br -Default: 8 - -.It Em PCVT_VT220KEYB -If activated, a keyboard layout resembling a DEC VT200 (TM) is generated. -If deactivated, a mixture between VT220 and HP is used. See the files -.Pa Keyboard.VT -and -.Pa Keyboard.HP -in the -.Nm pcvt -documentation directory for a full description. -.br -Default: off - -.It Em PCVT_SCREENSAVER -Enables the builtin screensaver feature. -.br -Default: on - -.It Em PCVT_PRETTYSCRNS -If enabled, a blinking-star screensaver is used. If disabled, the screen -is simply blanked -.Pq which might be useful for energy-saving monitors . -.br -Default: on - -.It Em PCVT_CTRL_ALT_DEL -If enabled, the key combination -.Aq Em Ctrl -.Aq Em Alt -.Aq Em Del -invokes a CPU reset. -.br -Default: off - -.It Em PCVT_USEKBDSEC -Do NOT override a security lock for the keyboard. -.br -Default: on - -.It Em PCVT_24LINESDEF -If enabled, the 25-line modi -.Po -VT emulation with 25 lines, and HP emulation with 28 lines -.Pc -default to 24 lines only to provide a better compatibility to the -original DEV VT220 (TM). Thus it should be possible to use the -terminal information for those terminals without further changes. -Note that this is a startup option; it is possible to toggle between -the 24- and 25-lines' display by the -.Xr scon 1 -utility. -.br -Default: off - -.It Em PCVT_EMU_MOUSE -Emulate a three-button mouse via the keypad. Useful for notebooks when -running XFree86. See -.Sx Mouse emulation -below. -.br -Default: off - -.It Em PCVT_META_ESC -If enabled, a sequence composed of -.Aq Em esc , -followed by the normal key code is emitted if a key is pressed with the -.Aq Em Alt -key modifier. If disabled, then normal key code with the value -.Em 0x80 -added is sent. -.br -Default: off - -.El - -Note that there are further options available which are mainly used for -debugging purposes or as a workaround for hardware problems. They are -found in -.Pa i386/isa/pcvt/pcvt_hdr.h -along with their documentation. - -.Ss Internal Functions -The functionality described below may be accessed via -.Xr ioctl 2 -system calls with a file descriptor opened on a device node -related to the -.Nm pcvt -driver. -To make use of them, a program should contain the following line: - - -.Dl #include - -Any parameter definitions cited below can be found in that file. - - -.Em Keyboard related functions - -Three functions are related to basic keyboard hardware: - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It KBDRESET -reset keyboard, set defaults; -.It KBDGTPMAT -get current typematic value, parameter is a pointer to int where -the values is stored to; -.It KBDSTPMAT -set current typematic value, similar to above command. -.El - -Symbolic values are available for the appropriate constants. -To specify the initial typematic delay time, they are -KBD_TPD250 for 250 ms through -KBD_TPD1000 for 1000 ms, in steps of 250 ms. The typematic repeat -rates are -KBD_TPM300, specifying 30.0 characters per second through -KBD_TPM20 for 2.0 characters per second. The intermediate values -are: 30.0, 26.7, 24.0, 21.8, 20.0, 18.5, 17.1, 16.0, 15.0, 13.3, -12.0, 10.9, 10.0, 9.2, 8.6, 8.0, 7.5, 6.7, 6.0, 5.5, 5.0, 4.6, 4.3, -4.0, 3.7, 3.3, 3.0, 2.7, 2.5, 2.3, 2.1, 2.0 characters per second. - - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It KBDGREPSW -get key repetition switch, and -.It KBDSREPSW -set key repetition switch -.El - -again take a pointer to int as argument. They manipulate the -drivers internal keyboard repetition flag, possible values are: -KBD_REPEATOFF or KBD_REPEATON. - - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It KBDGLEDS -get LED state, and -.It KBDSLEDS -set LED state manipulate the keyboard indicators, but do not influence -the drivers idea of lock key state. -.El - -The int where the argument points to -may have the values -KBD_SCROLLLOCK, KBD_NUMLOCK, KBD_CAPSLOCK, which may be used in any -conjunction. - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It KBDGLOCK -gets state of SCROLL,NUM,CAPS, and -.It KBDSLOCK -sets state of SCROLL,NUM,CAPS + LEDs -.El - -should be used in a same manner to get/set the drivers internal -LED flags. - - -.Em Keyboard remapping - -One important feature of the -.Nm pcvt -driver is its ability to overload the built in key definition. - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It KBDGCKEY -get current key values, -.It KBDSCKEY -set new key assignment values, and -.It KBDGOKEY -get original key assignment values -.El - -arrange those functions. The take a pointer to a -.Em struct kbd_ovlkey -as argument as described below. In addition, - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It KBDRMKEY -removes a key assignment, taking a pointer to an int as argument which -contains the affected key number; -.It KBDDEFAULT -removes all key assignments. -.El -.Bd -literal -struct kbd_ovlkey /* complete definition of a key */ -{ - u_short keynum; /* the key itself */ - u_short type; /* type of key, see below */ - u_char subu; /* subtype, ignored on write */ - char unshift[KBDMAXOVLKEYSIZE+1]; /* emitted string, unshifted */ - u_char subs; /* subtype, ignored on write */ - char shift[KBDMAXOVLKEYSIZE+1]; /* emitted string, shifted */ - u_char subc; /* subtype, ignored on write */ - char ctrl[KBDMAXOVLKEYSIZE+1]; /* emitted string, control */ - u_char suba; /* subtype, ignored on write */ - char altgr[KBDMAXOVLKEYSIZE+1]; /* emitted string, altgr */ -}; -.Ed - -The appropriate values for the -.Em type -field are: - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It KBD_NONE -no function, key is disabled, -.It KBD_SHIFT -keyboard shift, -.It KBD_META -alternate shift, sets bit8 to ASCII code, -.It KBD_NUM -numeric shift, keypad numeric / application mode, -.It KBD_CTL -control code generation, -.It KBD_CAPS -caps shift - swaps case of letter, -.It KBD_ASCII -ASCII code generating key, -.It KBD_SCROLL -stop output, -.It KBD_FUNC -function key, -.It KBD_KP -keypad keys, -.It KBD_BREAK -ignored, -.It KBD_ALTGR -AltGr translation feature, -.It KBD_SHFTLOCK -shift lock, -.It KBD_CURSOR -cursor keys, and -.It KBD_RETURN -.Dq Return -or -.Dq Enter -keys. -.El - -The -.Em subtype -field contains one of the values - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It KBD_SUBT_STR -key is bound to a string, or -.It KBD_SUBT_FNC -key is bound to a function. -.El - -.Em Mouse emulation - -The mouse emulator -.Pq if configured in -fakes a three-button mouse using the Mouse Systems protocol. The first -.Nm pcvt -device node not used by a virtual screen is the mouse device. I.\& e., -for the default value of 8 virtual screens, -.Pa /dev/ttyv0 -through -.Pa /dev/ttyv7 -would refer to the virtual screens, and -.Pa /dev/ttyv8 -were the mouse emulator device. The mouse emulation is turned on by -pressing the -.Aq Em NumLock -key. The pointer is moved by the numerical keypad keys, into the -obvious directions. The pointer is initially moved in single steps, -and is accelerated after an adjustable time -.Pq default: 500 ms -by about 6 times. The mouse buttons are emulated by three normal -keys, by default the function keys -.Aq Em \&F1 , -.Aq Em \&F2 , -and -.Aq Em \&F3 . -There are two selectable flavors available: normal and -.Dq sticky -buttons. Normal buttons behave as expected. -.Dq Sticky -buttons are notified as button-press on the first keypress. They -.Dq stick -until the key is pressed again -.Pq or another button-emulating key instead . -Button presses and releases are notified to the user by a simple -.Dq pling , -or -.Dq plong , -respectively, generated from the PC's built-in speaker. - -The following commands control the emulation. - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It KBDMOUSEGET -get the current definitions, and -.It KBDMOUSESET -set new definitions. -.El - -Both accept a -.Li struct mousedefs * -as the third argument to the ioctl call: -.Bd -literal -struct mousedefs { - int leftbutton; /* (PC) scan code for "left button" key */ - int middlebutton; /* (PC) scan code for "mid button" key */ - int rightbutton; /* (PC) scan code for "right button" key */ - int stickybuttons; /* if true, the buttons are "sticky" */ - int acceltime; /* timeout in microseconds to start pointer */ - /* movement acceleration */ - /* defaults to: scan(F1), scan(F2), scan(F3), false, 500000 */ -}; -.Ed - - -.Em Downloadable character set interface - -EGA and VGA video adaptors provide the capability of downloadable -software fonts. Since the -.Sq native character set -of any IBM-compatible PC video board does not allow the full interpretation -of DEC multinational character set or ISO Latin-1 -.Pq ISO 8859-1 , -this might be very useful for a U**X environment. - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It VGASETFONTATTR -set font attr, and -.It VGAGETFONTATTR -get font attr -.El - -are used to manipulate the drivers information about a downloaded -font. The take a pointer to a -.Em struct vgafontattr -as argument: -.Bd -literal -struct vgafontattr { - int character_set; /* VGA character set */ - int font_loaded; /* Mark font loaded or unloaded */ - int screen_size; /* Character rows per screen */ - int character_scanlines; /* Scanlines per character - 1 */ - int screen_scanlines; /* Scanlines per screen - 1 byte */ -}; -.Ed - -Each character of each font is to be downloaded with - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It VGALOADCHAR -load vga char, -.El - -taking a pointer to -.Em struct vgaloadchar -as its argument: -.Bd -literal -struct vgaloadchar { - int character_set; /* VGA character set to load into */ - int character; /* Character to load */ - int character_scanlines; /* Scanlines per character */ - u_char char_table[32]; /* VGA character shape table */ -}; -.Ed - -The field -.Em character_set -takes the values -CH_SET0, CH_SET1, CH_SET2, CH_SET3 on EGA's or VGA's. Since VGA's -might have up to eight simultaneously loaded fonts, they can take -CH_SET4, CH_SET5, CH_SET6, or CH_SET7, too. - -Note that there's a dependence between the font size -and a possible screen height -.Pq in character rows , -depending on the video adaptor used: -.Bd -literal -Screen size (rows) on: EGA VGA -Font size - -8 x 8 43 50 -8 x 10 35 40 -8 x 14 25 28 -8 x 16 not 25 - applicable -.Ed - - -.Em General screen manipulation commands - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It VGACURSOR -sets cursor shape, -.El - -taking a pointer to the following structure as argument: -.Bd -literal -struct cursorshape { - int screen_no; /* screen number for which to set, */ - /* or -1 to set on current active screen */ - int start; /* top scanline, range 0... Character Height - 1 */ - int end; /* end scanline, range 0... Character Height - 1 */ -}; -.Ed - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It VGASETSCREEN -set screen info, and -.It VGAGETSCREEN -get screen info, -.El - -provide an interface to some general driver internal variables -which might modify the behaviour of the screens, -or which might simply be used to force the driver to switch -to one certain screen. Their argument is a pointer to the structure: -.Bd -literal -struct screeninfo { - int adaptor_type; /* type of video adaptor installed */ - /* read only, ignored on write (yet!) */ - int totalfonts; /* no of downloadable fonts */ - /* read only, ignored on write */ - int totalscreens; /* no of virtual screens */ - /* read only, ignored on write */ - int screen_no; /* screen number, this was got from */ - /* on write, if -1, apply pure_vt_mode */ - /* and/or screen_size to current screen*/ - /* else to screen_no supplied */ - int current_screen; /* screen number, which is displayed. */ - /* on write, if -1, make this screen */ - /* the current screen, else set current*/ - /* displayed screen to parameter */ - int pure_vt_mode; /* flag, pure VT mode or HP/VT mode */ - /* on write, if -1, no change */ - int screen_size; /* screen size */ - /* on write, if -1, no change */ - int force_24lines; /* force 24 lines if 25 lines VT mode */ - /* or 28 lines HP mode to get pure */ - /* VT220 screen size */ - /* on write, if -1, no change */ - int vga_family; /* if adaptor_type = VGA, this reflects*/ - /* the chipset family after a read */ - /* nothing happenes on write ... */ - int vga_type; /* if adaptor_type = VGA, this reflects*/ - /* the chipset after a read */ - /* nothing happenes on write ... */ - int vga_132; /* set to 1 if driver has support for */ - /* 132 column operation for chipset */ - /* currently ignored on write */ -}; -.Ed - -Its field -.Em pure_vt_mode -may take the values M_HPVT for a mixed VTxxx and HP Mode, with function -key labels and a status line, or M_PUREVT for only VTxxx sequences -recognized, with no labels. - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It VGASETCOLMS -sets the number of columns for the current screen, -.El - -its parameter is a pointer to an integer containing either a value of 80, -or a value of 132. Note that setting the number of columns to 132 is -only supported on VGA adaptors. Any unsupported numbers cause the ioctl -to fail with -.Em errno -.Pq see Xr intro 2 -being set to -.Em EINVAL . - -.Em VGA color palette interface - -Only on VGA adaptors, there's a color palette register at the output. -It is responsible for the red, green and blue output voltage provided -for each of the 256 internal color codes, each lying in the range of -0 through 63 (with 63 representing the brightest value for a base color). -Thus, these adaptors map each color code to a color of a -.Dq palette -out of 262144 colors. The commands - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It VGAREADPEL -read VGA palette entry, and -.It VGAWRITEPEL -write VGA palette entry -.El - -establish an interface to these palette registers. Their argument is -a pointer to: -.Bd -literal -struct vgapel { - unsigned idx; /* index into palette, 0 .. 255 valid */ - unsigned r, g, b; /* RGB values, masked by VGA_PMASK (63) */ -}; -.Ed - - -.Em Driver identification - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It VGAPCVTID -returns information if the current compiled in driver is pcvt and it's -major and minor revision numbers. the call is taking a pointer to the -following structure as argument: -.El - -.Bd -literal -struct pcvtid { -#define PCVTIDNAMELN 16 /* driver id - string length */ - char name[PCVTIDNAMELN]; /* driver name, == PCVTIDSTR */ -#define PCVTIDNAME "pcvt" /* driver id - string */ - int rmajor; /* revision number, major */ -#define PCVTIDMAJOR 3 - int rminor; /* revision number, minor */ -#define PCVTIDMINOR 00 -}; -.Ed - - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It VGAPCVTINFO -returns information if the current compiled in driver is pcvt and it's -compile time options. the call is taking a pointer to the following -structure as argument: -.El - -.Bd -literal -struct pcvtinfo { - u_int opsys; /* PCVT_xxx(x)BSD */ -#define CONF_UNKNOWNOPSYS 0 -#define CONF_386BSD 1 /* unsupported !!! */ -#define CONF_NETBSD 2 -#define CONF_FREEBSD 3 - u_int opsysrel; /* Release for NetBSD/FreeBSD */ - u_int nscreens; /* PCVT_NSCREENS */ - u_int scanset; /* PCVT_SCANSET */ - u_int updatefast; /* PCVT_UPDATEFAST */ - u_int updateslow; /* PCVT_UPDATESLOW */ - u_int sysbeepf; /* PCVT_SYSBEEPF */ - u_int pcburst; /* PCVT_PCBURST */ - u_int kbd_fifo_sz; /* PCVT_KBD_FIFO_SZ */ - -/* config booleans */ - - u_long compile_opts; /* PCVT_xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx */ -}; -.Ed - - -.Em Screen saver - -Depending on the configuration of a -.Nm pcvt -driver, their might be a simple screen saver available. It is controlled -by the command - -.Bl -tag -width 20n -offset indent -compact -.It VGASCREENSAVER -set timeout for screen saver in seconds; 0 turns it off, -.El - -taking a pointer to an integer as argument. Despite of its command name, -this is available on -.Em any -kind of adaptor if configured in by the -.Xr config 8 -option -.Dq PCVT_SCREENSAVER - -.Em Compatibility commands for USL-style VT's - -Release 3.00 of this -.Nm pcvt -driver supports a subset of the USL-style commands used to control -the virtual terminal interface. This feature is mainly intended to -allow -.Em XFree86 , -release 2.0 or higher, to switch between virtual screens even when -running an X server. They are ugly with respect to the implied semantics -.Pq i.\& e., they break Berkeley semantics -and are therefore not recommended for common use. See the file -.Pa i386/include/pcvt_ioctl.h -for their documentation. - -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width /usr/include/machine/pcvt_ioctl.h -.It Pa /usr/include/machine/pcvt_ioctl.h -Definitions for -.Xr ioctl 2 -function calls -.It Pa /dev/ttyv? -.It Pa /dev/console -Device nodes to access the -.Nm pcvt -driver -.It Pa i386/isa/pcvt/pcvt_hdr.h -.Pq relative to the kernel source tree -Documents the various compile-time options to tailor -.Nm pcvt . -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm pcvt -driver has been developed for and contributed to 386BSD release 0.1. Since -release 3.00 explicit support is provided for NetBSD 0.9. It is expected -that no further development on pcvt is done for 386BSD 0.1 after release 3.00, -in fact, 386BSD support was dropped with release 3.20. -.Sh AUTHORS -Written by -.An Hellmuth Michaelis Aq hm@hcshh.hcs.de -with much help from -.An Brian Dunford-Shore Aq brian@morpheus.wustl.edu -.br -.if n Joerg Wunsch -.if t J\(:org Wunsch -.Aq joerg_wunsch@uriah.sax.de -.br -This driver is based on several people's previous -work, notably by -.An William Jolitz' -and -.An Don Ahn's -historic -.Xr pccons 4 -implementation -.br -.Aq ljolitz@cardio.ucsf.edu -.br -.An Holger Veit Aq veit@first.gmd.de -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr intro 2 , -.Xr ioctl 2 , -.Xr atkbd 4 , -.Xr keyboard 4 , -.Xr screen 4 , -.Xr config 8 , -.Xr ispcvt 8 -.Sh BUGS -Certainly existent. See the file -.Pa BugList -in the Documentation directory for an up-to-date list. - -.Ss Tested Video Boards -.Bd -literal -Manufacturer Chipset Monitor - -2theMax (?) ET4000 VGA Color -Video7 Inc. Video 7 VGA Color -Diamond Stealth VRAM S3 NEC 3FGx -Trident TVGA 8800CS NEC 3D -Data General C&T P82C604 VGA Color -NoName Hercules W86855AF Mono -Kyocera (Mainboard) WD90C11 Sony Color -unknown ET3000 NEC 3D -.Ed - -.Ss Tested Keyboards -.Bd -literal -Manufacturer Type Layout - -Cherry MF II US -Cherry/Tandon MF II German -Hewlett-Packard MF II US -Hewlett-Packard MF II German -Tatung AT German -.Ed - -There is absolutely NO support for the ancient PC-keyboards -.Pq they had 83 keys . - -There is only limited support for AT-keyboards -.Bo -they have 84 keys, and a separate numeric keypad, -they don't have F11/F12 keys -.Bc -because the emulator needs F9 through F12 for control functions, and due to -the current design of the keyboard driver there is no -.Pq full -support for national keyboards because -of the lack of an ALtGr key. - -MF-keyboards are fully supported, 101- and 102-key versions. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/pn.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/pn.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 57847797b612..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/pn.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,160 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd November 7, 1998 -.Dt PN 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm pn -.Nd -Lite-On 82c168/82c169 PNIC fast ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device pn0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI ethernet adapters and embedded -controllers based on the Lite-On 82c168 and 82c169 fast ethernet -controller chips. This includes the LinkSys LNE100TX, the -Bay Networks Netgear FA310TX revision D1, the Matrox Networks -FastNIC 10/100, the Kingston KNE110TX (EtherRx VP), -and various other commodity fast ethernet cards. -.Pp -The Lite-On chips use bus master DMA and are designed to be -DEC 'tulip' workalikes. Many vendors that formerly based their -designs around the DEC 21x4x devices are now using the PNIC -instead. The chips support both an internal transceiver -and external transceivers via an MII bus. The Lite-On parts are -advertised as being register compatible with the DEC 21x4x -controllers, however there are some differences in the way the -EEPROM and MII access is done. The PNIC controllers support both -10 and 100Mbps speeds in either full or half duplex. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. -The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -fine. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -Note that the 100baseTX media type is only available if supported -by the adapter. -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "pn%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "pn%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "pn%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.It "pn%d: no memory for rx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the receiver ring. -.It "pn%d: no memory for tx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the transmitter ring when -allocating a pad buffer or collapsing an mbuf chain into a cluster. -.It "pn%d: chip is in D3 power state -- setting to D0" -This message applies only to adapters which support power -management. Some operating systems place the controller in low power -mode when shutting down, and some PCI BIOSes fail to bring the chip -out of this state before configuring it. The controller loses all of -its PCI configuration in the D3 state, so if the BIOS does not set -it back to full power mode in time, it won't be able to configure it -correctly. The driver tries to detect this condition and bring -the adapter back to the D0 (full power) state, but this may not be -enough to return the driver to a fully operational condition. If -you see this message at boot time and the driver fails to attach -the device as a network interface, you will have to perform second -warm boot to have the device properly configured. -.Pp -Note that this condition only occurs when warm booting from another -operating system. If you power down your system prior to booting -.Fx , -the card should be configured correctly. -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ctr.columbia.edu . -.Sh BUGS -The internal NWAY support on the 82c168 chip is horribly broken, which -means that autoselection will not work, except maybe for half-duplex -10Mbps links. In order to use other modes (e.g. 100Mbps) it will be -necessary to -use -.Xr ifconfig 8 -to set the interface manually. Autoselection for 82c169 boards using -MII transceivers should work correctly. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/psm.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/psm.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 3138d1e375c0..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/psm.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,771 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1997 -.\" Kazutaka YOKOTA -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer as -.\" the first lines of this file unmodified. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd January 30, 1999 -.Dt PSM 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm psm -.Nd -PS/2 mouse style pointing device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "options" \&"PSM_HOOKAPM\&" -.Cd "options" \&"PSM_RESETAFTERSUSPEND\&" -.Cd "options" \&"KBD_RESETDELAY=N\&" -.Cd "options" \&"KBD_MAXWAIT=N\&" -.Cd "options" \&"PSM_DEBUG=N\&" -.Cd "options" \&"KBDIO_DEBUG=N\&" -.Cd "device psm0 at atkbdc? irq 12" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for the PS/2 mouse style pointing device. -Currently there can be only one -.Nm -device node in the system. -As the PS/2 mouse port is located -at the auxiliary port of the keyboard controller, -the keyboard controller driver, -.Nm atkbdc , -must also be configured in the kernel. -Note that there is currently no provision of changing the -.Em irq -number. -.Pp -Basic PS/2 style pointing device has two or three buttons. -Some devices may have a roller or a wheel and/or additional buttons. -.Ss Device Resolution -The PS/2 style pointing device usually has several grades of resolution, -that is, sensitivity of movement. They are typically 25, 50, 100 and 200 -pulse per inch. Some devices may have finer resolution. -The current resolution can be changed at runtime. The -.Nm -driver allows the user to initially set the resolution -via the driver flag -.Pq see Sx DRIVER CONFIGURATION -or change it later via the -.Xr ioctl 2 -command -.Dv MOUSE_SETMODE -.Pq see Sx IOCTLS . -.Ss Report Rate -Frequency, or report rate, at which the device sends movement -and button state reports to the host system is also configurable. -The PS/2 style pointing device typically supports 10, 20, 40, 60, 80, 100 -and 200 reports per second. -60 or 100 appears to be the default value for many devices. -Note that when there is no movement and no button has changed its state, -the device won't send anything to the host system. -The report rate can be changed via an ioctl call. -.Ss Operation Levels -The -.Nm -driver has three levels of operation. -The current operation level can be set via an ioctl call. -.Pp -At the level zero the basic support is provided; the device driver will report -horizontal and vertical movement of the attached device -and state of up to three buttons. -The movement and status are encoded in a series of fixed-length data packets -.Pq see Sx Data Packet Format . -This is the default level of operation and the driver is initially -at this level when opened by the user program. -.Pp -The operation level one, the `extended' level, supports a roller (or wheel), -if any, and up to 11 buttons. -The movement of the roller is reported as movement along the Z axis. -8 byte data packets are sent to the user program at this level. -.Pp -At the operation level two, data from the pointing device is passed to the -user program as is. -Modern PS/2 type pointing devices often use proprietary data format. -Therefore, the user program is expected to have -intimate knowledge about the format from a particular device when operating -the driver at this level. -This level is called `native' level. -.Ss Data Packet Format -Data packets read from the -.Nm -driver are formatted differently at each operation level. -.Pp -A data packet from the PS/2 mouse style pointing device -is three bytes long at the operation level zero: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width Byte_1 -compact -.It Byte 1 -.Bl -tag -width bit_7 -compact -.It bit 7 -One indicates overflow in the vertical movement count. -.It bit 6 -One indicates overflow in the horizontal movement count. -.It bit 5 -Set if the vertical movement count is negative. -.It bit 4 -Set if the horizontal movement count is negative. -.It bit 3 -Always one. -.\" The ALPS GlidePoint clears this bit when the user `taps' the surface of -.\" the pad, otherwise the bit is set. -.\" Most, if not all, other devices always set this bit. -.It bit 2 -Middle button status; set if pressed. For devices without the middle -button, this bit is always zero. -.It bit 1 -Right button status; set if pressed. -.It bit 0 -Left button status; set if pressed. -.El -.It Byte 2 -Horizontal movement count in two's compliment; --256 through 255. -Note that the sign bit is in the first byte. -.It Byte 3 -Vertical movement count in two's compliment; --256 through 255. -Note that the sign bit is in the first byte. -.El -.Pp -At the level one, a data packet is encoded -in the standard format -.Dv MOUSE_PROTO_SYSMOUSE -as defined in -.Xr mouse 4 . -.Pp -At the level two, native level, there is no standard on the size and format -of the data packet. -.Ss Acceleration -The -.Nm -driver can somewhat `accelerate' the movement of the pointing device. -The faster you move the device, the further the pointer -travels on the screen. -The driver has an internal variable which governs the effect of -the acceleration. Its value can be modified via the driver flag -or via an ioctl call. -.Ss Device Number -The minor device number of the -.Nm -is made up of: -.Bd -literal -offset indent -minor = (`unit' << 1) | `non-blocking' -.Ed -.Pp -where `unit' is the device number (usually 0) and the `non-blocking' bit -is set to indicate ``don't block waiting for mouse input, -return immediately''. -The `non-blocking' bit should be set for \fIXFree86\fP, -therefore the minor device number usually used for \fIXFree86\fP is 1. -See -.Sx FILES -for device node names. -.Sh DRIVER CONFIGURATION -.Ss Kernel Configuration Options -There are following kernel configuration options to control the -.Nm -driver. -They may be set in the kernel configuration file -.Pq see Xr config 8 . -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE -.It Em PSM_HOOKAPM -The built-in PS/2 pointing device of some laptop computers is somehow -not operable immediately after the system `resumes' from -the power saving mode, -though it will eventually become available. -There are reports that -stimulating the device by performing I/O will help -waking up the device quickly. This option will add a piece of code -to the -.Nm -driver to hook -the APM `resume' event and exercise some harmless I/O operations to the -device. -.It Em PSM_RESETAFTERSUSPEND -This option adds more drastic action for the above problem. -It will make the -.Nm -driver to reset the pointing device after the APM resume event. -It has no effect unless the -.Em PSM_HOOKAPM -option is enabled as well. -.It Em KBD_RESETDELAY=X, KBD_MAXWAIT=Y -The -.Nm -driver will attempt to reset the pointing device during the boot process. -It sometimes takes a long while before the device will respond after -reset. These options control how long the driver should wait before -it eventually gives up waiting. The driver will wait -.Fa X -* -.Fa Y -msecs at most. If the driver seems unable to detect your pointing -device, you may want to increase these values. The default values are -200 msec for -.Fa X -and 5 -for -.Fa Y . -.It Em PSM_DEBUG=N, KBDIO_DEBUG=N -Sets the debug level to -.Fa N . -The default debug level is zero. See -.Sx DIAGNOSTICS -for debug logging. -.El -.Ss Driver Flags -The -.Nm -driver accepts the following driver flags. Set them in the -kernel configuration file or in the User Configuration Menu at -the boot time -.Pq see Xr boot 8 . -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE -.It bit 0..3 RESOLUTION -This flag specifies the resolution of the pointing device. -It must be zero through four. The greater the value -is, the finer resolution the device will select. -Actual resolution selected by this field varies according to the model -of the device. Typical resolutions are: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width 0_(medium_high)__ -compact -.It Em 1 (low) -25 pulse per inch (ppi) -.It Em 2 (medium low) -50 ppi -.It Em 3 (medium high) -100 ppi -.It Em 4 (high) -200 ppi -.El -.Pp -Leaving this flag zero will selects the default resolution for the -device (whatever it is). -.It bit 4..7 ACCELERATION -This flag controls the amount of acceleration effect. -The smaller the value of this flag is, more sensitive the movement becomes. -The minimum value allowed, thus the value for the most sensitive setting, -is one. Setting this flag to zero will completely disables the -acceleration effect. -.It bit 8 NOCHECKSYNC -The -.Nm -driver tries to detect the first byte of the data packet by checking -the bit pattern of that byte. Although this method should work with most -PS/2 pointing devices, it may interfere with some devices which are not -so compatible with known devices. -If you think your pointing device is not functioning as expected, -and the kernel frequently prints the following message to the console, -.Bd -literal -offset indent -psmintr: out of sync (xxxx != yyyy). -.Ed -.Pp -set this flag to disable synchronization check and see if it helps. -.It bit 9 NOIDPROBE -The -.Nm -driver will not try to identify the model of the pointing device and -will not carry out model-specific initialization. -The device should always act like a standard PS/2 mouse without such -initialization. -Extra features, such as wheels and additional buttons, won't be -recognized by the -.Nm -driver. -.It bit 10 NORESET -When this flag is set, the -.Nm -driver won't reset the pointing device when initializing the device. -If the FreeBSD kernel -is started after another OS has run, the pointing device will inherit -settings from the previous OS. -However, because there is no way for the -.Nm -driver to know the settings, the device and the driver may not -work correctly. -The flag should never be necessary under normal circumstances. -.It bit 11 FORCETAP -Some pad devices report as if the fourth button is pressed -when the user `taps' the surface of the device (see -.Sx CAVEATS ) . -This flag will make the -.Nm -driver assume that the device behaves this way. -Without the flag, the driver will assume this behavior -for ALPS GlidePoint models only. -.It bit 12 IGNOREPORTERROR -This flag makes -.Nm -driver ignore certain error conditions when probing the PS/2 mouse port. -It should never be necessary under normal circumstances. -.El -.Sh IOCTLS -There are a few -.Xr ioctl 2 -commands for mouse drivers. -These commands and related structures and constants are defined in -.Ao Pa machine/mouse.h Ac . -General description of the commands is given in -.Xr mouse 4 . -This section explains the features specific to the -.Nm -driver. -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE -compact -.It Dv MOUSE_GETLEVEL Ar int *level -.It Dv MOUSE_SETLEVEL Ar int *level -These commands manipulate the operation level of the -.Nm -driver. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_GETHWINFO Ar mousehw_t *hw -Returns the hardware information of the attached device in the following -structure. -.Bd -literal -typedef struct mousehw { - int buttons; /* number of buttons */ - int iftype; /* I/F type */ - int type; /* mouse/track ball/pad... */ - int model; /* I/F dependent model ID */ - int hwid; /* I/F dependent hardware ID */ -} mousehw_t; -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Dv buttons -field holds the number of buttons on the device. -The -.Nm -driver currently can detect the 3 button mouse from Logitech and report -accordingly. -The 3 button mouse from the other manufacturer may or may not be -reported correctly. However, it will not affect the operation of -the driver. -.Pp -The -.Dv iftype -is always -.Dv MOUSE_IF_PS2 . -.Pp -The -.Dv type -tells the device type: -.Dv MOUSE_MOUSE , -.Dv MOUSE_TRACKBALL , -.Dv MOUSE_STICK , -.Dv MOUSE_PAD , -or -.Dv MOUSE_UNKNOWN . -The user should not heavily rely on this field, as the -driver may not always, in fact it is very rarely able to, identify -the device type. -.Pp -The -.Dv model -is always -.Dv MOUSE_MODEL_GENERIC -at the operation level 0. -It may be -.Dv MOUSE_MODEL_GENERIC -or one of -.Dv MOUSE_MODEL_XXX -constants at higher operation levels. -Again the -.Nm -driver may or may not set an appropriate value in this field. -.Pp -The -.Dv hwid -is the ID value returned by the device. -Known IDs include: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width 0__ -compact -.It Em 0 -Mouse (Microsoft, Logitech and many other manufacturers) -.It Em 2 -Microsoft Ballpoint mouse -.It Em 3 -Microsoft IntelliMouse -.El -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_GETMODE Ar mousemode_t *mode -The command gets the current operation parameters of the mouse -driver. -.Bd -literal -typedef struct mousemode { - int protocol; /* MOUSE_PROTO_XXX */ - int rate; /* report rate (per sec), -1 if unknown */ - int resolution; /* MOUSE_RES_XXX, -1 if unknown */ - int accelfactor; /* acceleration factor */ - int level; /* driver operation level */ - int packetsize; /* the length of the data packet */ - unsigned char syncmask[2]; /* sync. bits */ -} mousemode_t; -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Dv protocol -is -.Dv MOUSE_PROTO_PS2 -at the operation level zero and two. -.Dv MOUSE_PROTO_SYSMOUSE -at the operation level one. -.Pp -The -.Dv rate -is the status report rate (reports/sec) at which the device will send -movement report to the host computer. -Typical supported values are 10, 20, 40, 60, 80, 100 and 200. -Some mice may accept other arbitrary values too. -.Pp -The -.Dv resolution -of the pointing device must be one of -.Dv MOUSE_RES_XXX -constants or a positive value. The greater the value -is, the finer resolution the mouse will select. -Actual resolution selected by the -.Dv MOUSE_RES_XXX -constant varies according to the model of mouse. Typical resolutions are: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE_RES_MEDIUMHIGH__ -compact -.It Dv MOUSE_RES_LOW -25 ppi -.It Dv MOUSE_RES_MEDIUMLOW -50 ppi -.It Dv MOUSE_RES_MEDIUMHIGH -100 ppi -.It Dv MOUSE_RES_HIGH -200 ppi -.El -.Pp -The -.Dv accelfactor -field holds a value to control acceleration feature -.Pq see Sx Acceleration . -It must be zero or greater. If it is zero, acceleration is disabled. -.Pp -The -.Dv packetsize -field specifies the length of the data packet. It depends on the -operation level and the model of the pointing device. -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width level_0__ -compact -.It Em level 0 -3 bytes -.It Em level 1 -8 bytes -.It Em level 2 -Depends on the model of the device -.El -.Pp -The array -.Dv syncmask -holds a bit mask and pattern to detect the first byte of the -data packet. -.Dv syncmask[0] -is the bit mask to be ANDed with a byte. If the result is equal to -.Dv syncmask[1] , -the byte is likely to be the first byte of the data packet. -Note that this detection method is not 100% reliable, -thus, should be taken only as an advisory measure. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_SETMODE Ar mousemode_t *mode -The command changes the current operation parameters of the mouse driver -as specified in -.Ar mode . -Only -.Dv rate , -.Dv resolution , -.Dv level -and -.Dv accelfactor -may be modifiable. Setting values in the other field does not generate -error and has no effect. -.Pp -If you do not want to change the current setting of a field, put -1 -there. -You may also put zero in -.Dv resolution -and -.Dv rate , -and the default value for the fields will be selected. -.\" .Pp -.\" .It Dv MOUSE_GETVARS Ar mousevar_t *vars -.\" .It Dv MOUSE_SETVARS Ar mousevar_t *vars -.\" These commands are not supported by the -.\" .Nm -.\" driver. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_READDATA Ar mousedata_t *data -.\" The command reads the raw data from the device. -.\" .Bd -literal -.\" typedef struct mousedata { -.\" int len; /* # of data in the buffer */ -.\" int buf[16]; /* data buffer */ -.\" } mousedata_t; -.\" .Ed -.\" .Pp -.\" Upon returning to the user program, the driver will place the number -.\" of valid data bytes in the buffer in the -.\" .Dv len -.\" field. -.\" .Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_READSTATE Ar mousedata_t *state -.\" The command reads the hardware settings from the device. -.\" Upon returning to the user program, the driver will place the number -.\" of valid data bytes in the buffer in the -.\" .Dv len -.\" field. It is usually 3 bytes. -.\" The buffer is formatted as follows: -.\" .Pp -.\" .Bl -tag -width Byte_1 -compact -.\" .It Byte 1 -.\" .Bl -tag -width bit_6 -compact -.\" .It bit 7 -.\" Reserved. -.\" .It bit 6 -.\" 0 - stream mode, 1 - remote mode. -.\" In the stream mode, the pointing device sends the device status -.\" whenever its state changes. In the remote mode, the host computer -.\" must request the status to be sent. -.\" The -.\" .Nm -.\" driver puts the device in the stream mode. -.\" .It bit 5 -.\" Set if the pointing device is currently enabled. Otherwise zero. -.\" .It bit 4 -.\" 0 - 1:1 scaling, 1 - 2:1 scaling. -.\" 1:1 scaling is the default. -.\" .It bit 3 -.\" Reserved. -.\" .It bit 2 -.\" Left button status; set if pressed. -.\" .It bit 1 -.\" Middle button status; set if pressed. -.\" .It bit 0 -.\" Right button status; set if pressed. -.\" .El -.\" .It Byte 2 -.\" .Bl -tag -width bit_6_0 -compact -.\" .It bit 7 -.\" Reserved. -.\" .It bit 6..0 -.\" Resolution code: zero through three. Actual resolution for -.\" the resolution code varies from one device to another. -.\" .El -.\" .It Byte 3 -.\" The status report rate (reports/sec) at which the device will send -.\" movement report to the host computer. -.\" .El -These commands are not currently supported by the -.Nm -driver. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_GETSTATUS Ar mousestatus_t *status -The command returns the current state of buttons and -movement counts as described in -.Xr mouse 4 . -.El -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width /dev/npsm0 -compact -.It Pa /dev/psm0 -`non-blocking' device node -.It Pa /dev/bpsm0 -`blocking' device node under -.Em devfs . -.El -.Sh EXAMPLE -.Dl "options" \&"PSM_HOOKAPM\&" -.Dl "device psm0 at atkbdc? irq 12" -.Pp -Add the -.Nm -driver to the kernel with the optional code to stimulate the pointing device -after the `resume' event. -.Pp -.Dl "device psm0 at atkbdc? flags 0x024 irq 12" -.Pp -Set the device resolution high (4) and the acceleration factor to 2. -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Pp -At debug level 0, little information is logged except for the following -line during boot process: -.Bd -literal -offset indent -psm0: device ID X -.Ed -.Pp -where -.Fa X -the device ID code returned by the found pointing device. -See -.Dv MOUSE_GETINFO -for known IDs. -.Pp -At debug level 1 more information will be logged -while the driver probes the auxiliary port (mouse port). -Messages are logged with the LOG_KERN facility at the LOG_DEBUG level -.Pq see Xr syslogd 8 . -.Bd -literal -offset indent -psm0: current command byte:xxxx -kbdio: TEST_AUX_PORT status:0000 -kbdio: RESET_AUX return code:00fa -kbdio: RESET_AUX status:00aa -kbdio: RESET_AUX ID:0000 -[...] -psm: status 00 02 64 -psm0 irq 12 on isa -psm0: model AAAA, device ID X, N buttons -psm0: config:00000www, flags:0000uuuu, packet size:M -psm0: syncmask:xx, syncbits:yy -.Ed -.Pp -The first line shows the command byte value of the keyboard -controller just before the auxiliary port is probed. -It usually is 4D, 45, 47 or 65, depending on how the motherboard BIOS -initialized the keyboard controller upon power-up. -.Pp -The second line shows the result of the keyboard controller's -test on the auxiliary port interface, with zero indicating -no error; note that some controllers report no error even if -the port does not exist in the system, however. -.Pp -The third through fifth lines show the reset status of the pointing device. -The functioning device should return the sequence of FA AA . -The ID code is described above. -.Pp -The seventh line shows the current hardware settings. -.\" See -.\" .Dv MOUSE_READSTATE -.\" for definitions. -These bytes are formatted as follows: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width Byte_1 -compact -.It Byte 1 -.Bl -tag -width bit_6 -compact -.It bit 7 -Reserved. -.It bit 6 -0 - stream mode, 1 - remote mode. -In the stream mode, the pointing device sends the device status -whenever its state changes. In the remote mode, the host computer -must request the status to be sent. -The -.Nm -driver puts the device in the stream mode. -.It bit 5 -Set if the pointing device is currently enabled. Otherwise zero. -.It bit 4 -0 - 1:1 scaling, 1 - 2:1 scaling. -1:1 scaling is the default. -.It bit 3 -Reserved. -.It bit 2 -Left button status; set if pressed. -.It bit 1 -Middle button status; set if pressed. -.It bit 0 -Right button status; set if pressed. -.El -.It Byte 2 -.Bl -tag -width bit_6_0 -compact -.It bit 7 -Reserved. -.It bit 6..0 -Resolution code: zero through three. Actual resolution for -the resolution code varies from one device to another. -.El -.It Byte 3 -The status report rate (reports/sec) at which the device will send -movement report to the host computer. -.El -.Pp -Note that the pointing device will not be enabled until the -.Nm -driver is opened by the user program. -.Pp -The rest of the lines show the device ID code, the number of detected -buttons and internal variables. -.Pp -At debug level 2, much more detailed information is logged. -.Sh CAVEATS -Many pad devices behave as if the first (left) button were pressed if -the user `taps' the surface of the pad. -In contrast, some pad products, e.g. some verions of ALPS GlidePoint -and Interlink VersaPad, treat the tapping action -as fourth button events. -.Pp -It is reported that Interlink VersaPad rquires both -.Em PSM_HOOKAPM -and -.Em PSM_RESETAFTERSUSPEND -options in order to recover from suspended state. -Add these options to your kernel configuration file if the device -does not seem to work properly after the system is resumed. -.Pp -Some PS/2 mouse models from MouseSystems require to be put in the -high resolution mode to work properly. Use the driver flag to -set resolution. -.Pp -There is not a guaranteed way to re-synchronize with the first byte -of the packet once we are out of synchronization with the data -stream. However, if you are using the \fIXFree86\fP server and experiencing -the problem, you may be able to make the X server synchronize with the mouse -by switching away to a virtual terminal and getting back to the X server, -unless the X server is accessing the mouse via -.Xr moused 8 . -Clicking any button without moving the mouse may also work. -.Sh BUGS -The ioctl command -.Dv MOUSEIOCREAD -has been removed. It was never functional anyway. -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr ioctl 2 , -.Xr syslog 3 , -.Xr atkbdc 4 , -.Xr mouse 4 , -.Xr mse 4 , -.Xr sysmouse 4 , -.Xr moused 8 , -.Xr syslogd 8 -.\".Sh HISTORY -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver is based on the work done by quite a number of people, including -.An Eric Forsberg , -.An Sandi Donno , -.An Rick Macklem , -.An Andrew Herbert , -.An Charles Hannum , -.An Shoji Yuen -and -.An Kazutaka Yokota -to name the few. -.Pp -This manual page was written by -.An Kazutaka Yokota Aq yokota@FreeBSD.org . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/rl.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/rl.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 84c9b91c11e5..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/rl.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,192 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd November 4, 1998 -.Dt RL 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm rl -.Nd -RealTek 8129/8139 fast ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device rl0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI ethernet adapters and embedded -controllers based on the RealTek 8129 and 8139 fast ethernet controller -chips. This includes the Allied Telesyn AT2550, Genius GF100TXR, -NDC Communications NE100TX-E, OvisLink LEF-8129TX, OvisLink LEF-8139TX, -Netronix Inc. EA-1210 NetEther 10/100, KTX-9130TX 10/100 Fast Ethernet, -Encore ENL832-TX 10/100 M PCI, Longshine LCS-8038TX-R, the -SMC EZ Card 10/100 PCI 1211-TX, and various other cheap adapters. -It also supports the Accton EN1207D which has a -chip labeled MPX5030 (or MPX5038) which appears to be a RealTek workalike. -.Pp -The RealTek controllers use bus master DMA but do not use a -descriptor-based data transfer mechanism. The receiver uses a -single fixed size ring buffer from which packets must be copied -into mbufs. For transmission, there are only four outbound packet -address registers which require all outgoing packets to be stored -as contiguous buffers. Furthermore, outbound packet buffers must -be longword aligned or else transmission will fail. -.Pp -The 8129 differs from the 8139 in that the 8139 has an internal -PHY which is controlled through special direct access registers -whereas the 8129 uses an external PHY via an MII bus. The 8139 -supports both 10 and 100Mbps speeds in either full or half duplex. -The 8129 can support the same speeds and modes given an appropriate -PHY chip. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. This is only -supported if the PHY chip attached to the RealTek controller -supports NWAY autonegotiation. The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -file. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -Note that the 100baseTX media type is only available if supported -by the adapter. -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "rl%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "rl%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "rl%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.It "rl%d: no memory for rx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the receiver ring. -.It "rl%d: no memory for tx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the transmitter ring when -allocating a pad buffer or collapsing an mbuf chain into a cluster. -.It "rl%d: chip is in D3 power state -- setting to D0" -This message applies only to adapters which support power -management. Some operating systems place the controller in low power -mode when shutting down, and some PCI BIOSes fail to bring the chip -out of this state before configuring it. The controller loses all of -its PCI configuration in the D3 state, so if the BIOS does not set -it back to full power mode in time, it won't be able to configure it -correctly. The driver tries to detect this condition and bring -the adapter back to the D0 (full power) state, but this may not be -enough to return the driver to a fully operational condition. If -you see this message at boot time and the driver fails to attach -the device as a network interface, you will have to perform second -warm boot to have the device properly configured. -.Pp -Note that this condition only occurs when warm booting from another -operating system. If you power down your system prior to booting -.Fx , -the card should be configured correctly. -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Rs -.%B The RealTek 8129 and 8139 datasheets -.%O ftp.realtek.com.tw:/lancard/data sheet -.Re -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ctr.columbia.edu . -.Sh BUGS -Since outbound packets must be longword aligned, the transmit -routine has to copy an unaligned packet into an mbuf cluster buffer -before transmission. The driver abuses the fact that the cluster buffer -pool is allocated at system startup time in a contiguous region starting -at a page boundary. Since cluster buffers are 2048 bytes, they are -longword aligned by definition. The driver probably should not be -depending on this characteristic. -.Pp -The RealTek data sheets are of especially poor quality: the grammar -and spelling are awful and there is a lot of information missing, -particularly concerning the receiver operation. One particularly -important fact that the data sheets fail to mention relates to the -way in which the chip fills in the receive buffer. When an interrupt -is posted to signal that a frame has been received, it is possible that -another frame might be in the process of being copied into the receive -buffer while the driver is busy handling the first one. If the driver -manages to finish processing the first frame before the chip is done -DMAing the rest of the next frame, the driver may attempt to process -the next frame in the buffer before the chip has had a chance to finish -DMAing all of it. -.Pp -The driver can check for an incomplete frame by inspecting the frame -length in the header preceeding the actual packet data: an incomplete -frame will have the magic length of 0xFFF0. When the driver encounters -this value, it knows that it has finished processing all currently -available packets. Neither this magic value nor its significance are -documented anywhere in the RealTek data sheets. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/screen.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/screen.4 deleted file mode 100644 index be40d4fcb03d..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/screen.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,166 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd January 8, 1995 -.Dt SCREEN 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm screen -.Nd pc display interface -.Sh DESCRIPTION - -Access to the -.Ar virtual consoles -are obtained through the device files -ttyv0 - ttyvb in /dev. -Each of these files correspond to a separate -virtual console. -All virtual console devices can be open at once, but only one is -active at a time. The active virtual console "owns" the keyboard and -display screen. -.Pp -Output to a virtual console that not currently is on the display is -saved in a buffer that holds a "screenfull" (normally 25) lines. -Any output written to -.Ar /dev/console -(the original console device) is echoed to /dev/ttyv0. -.Pp -To switch between the virtual consoles one uses the sequence -.Ar ALT+Fn -, which means hold down ALT and press one of the function keys. The -virtual console with the same number as the function key is then -selected as the current virtual console, and given exclusive use of -the keyboard and display. This switch sequence can be changed via -the keyboard mapping ioctl call (see keyboard.4) -.Pp - -The console allows entering values that are not physically -present on the keyboard via a special keysequence. -To use this facility press and hold down ALT, -then enter a decimal number from 0-255 via the numerical keypad, then -release ALT. The entered value is then used as the ASCII value for one -character. This way it is possible to enter any ASCII value. -The console driver also includes a history function. It is activated by -pressing the scroll-lock key. This holds the display, and enables the cursor -arrows for scrolling up and down through the last scrolled out lines. - -The console understands a subset of the ANSI x3.64 character -sequences. For compatibility with the old pccons, the PC3 character -sequences is also supported. -.Pp -.Bd -literal -ANSI Seq Function Termcap entry -======= ======= ===================================== ============== - --- E7 Save cursor position sc - --- E8 Restore saved cursor position rc - -CUU E[nA move cursor up n lines up/UP (ku) - -CUD E[nB move cursor down n lines do/DO (kd) - -CUF E[nC move cursor right n characters nd/RI (kr) - -CUB E[nD move cursor left n characters --/LE (kl) - -HPA E[n` move cursor to character position n ch - -HPR E[na move cursor right n characters -- - -VPA E[nd move cursor to line n cv - -VPR E[ne move cursor down n lines -- - -CPL E[nF move cursor to start of line, -- (@7) - n lines up - -CNL E[nE move cursor to start of line, nw - n lines down - -CUP E[y;xH Move cursor to x, y cm - -HVP E[y;xf Move cursor to x, y -- - -CBT E[nZ Move cursor back n tab stops bt (kB) - -IL E[nL Insert n blank lines al/AL - -ICH E[n@ Insert n blank characters ic/IC - -DL E[nM Delete n lines dl/DL - -DCH E[nP Delete n characters dc/DC - -ED E[nJ Erase part or all of display: cd - n=0 from cursor to end of display, - n=1 from begin of display to cursor, - n=2 entire display. - -EL E[nK Erase part or all of line: ce - n=0 from cursor to end of line, - n=1 from begin of line to cursor, - n=2 entire line. - -ECH E[nX Erase n characters ec - -SU E[nS Scroll display n lines up (forward) sf/SF - -SD E[nT Scroll display n lines down (reverse) sr/SR - - -SGR E[nm Set character attributes: -- - n= 0 normal attribute (all off) - n= 1 bold (highlight) - n= 4 underscore (if supported by HW) - n= 5 blink (if supported by HW) - n= 7 reverse - n=3X set foreground color (see table) - n=4X set background color (see table) - - X=0 black X=1 red - X=2 green X=3 brown - X=4 blue X=5 magenta - X=6 cyan X=7 white - --- E[s Save cursor position sc - --- E[u Restore saved cursor position rc - --- E[=p;dB Set bell pitch (p) and duration (d), -- - picth is in units of 840 nS, - duration is units of 0,1 S. - --- E[=tC Set cursor type, 1 selects a blinking -- - cursor, 0 a steady cursor. - --- E[=nA Set the border color to color n - (see table) (if supported by HW) - --- E[=nF set normal foreground color to n -- - (see table) - --- E[=nG set normal background color to n -- - (see table) - --- E[=nH set reverse foreground color to n -- - (see table) - --- E[=nI set reverse background color to n -- - (see table) - - n= 0 black n= 8 grey - n= 1 blue n= 9 light blue - n= 2 green n=10 light green - n= 3 cyan n=11 light cyan - n= 4 red n=12 light red - n= 5 magenta n=13 light magenta - n= 6 brown n=14 yellow - n= 7 white n=15 light white - -note: the first E in the sequences stands for ESC (0x1b) - -.Ed -.Pp -.Sh AUTHORS -.An Søren Schmidt Aq sos@FreeBSD.org diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sf.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sf.4 deleted file mode 100644 index a525f25c3c81..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sf.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,161 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998, 1999 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd July 22, 1999 -.Dt SF 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm sf -.Nd -Adaptec AIC-6915 "Starfire" PCI fast ethernet adapter driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device sf0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for Adaptec Duralink fast ethernet adapters -based on the Adaptec AIC-6915 "Starfire" chipset. This includes the -following: -.Bl -bullet -offset indent -.It -ANA-62011 64-bit single port 10/100baseTX adapter -.It -ANA-62022 64-bit dual port 10/100baseTX adapter -.It -ANA-62044 64-bit quad port 10/100baseTX adapter -.It -ANA-69011 32-bit single port 10/100baseTX adapter -.It -ANA-62020 64-bit single port 100baseFX adapter -.El -.Pp -The AIC-6915 is a bus master controller with an MII interface. It -supports high and low priority transmit and receive queues, TCP/IP -checksum offload, multiple DMA descriptor formats and both polling -and producer/consumer DMA models. The AIC-6915 receive filtering -options include a 16 entry perfect filter, a 512-bit hash table -for multicast addresses, a 512-bit hash table for priority address -matching and VLAN filtering. An external MII-compliant transceiver -is required for media interfacing. -.Pp -Multiport adapters consist of several AIC-6915 controllers connected -via a PCI to PCI bridge. Each controller is treated as a separate -interface by the -.Nm -driver. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. -The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -file. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "sf%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. This may -happen if the PCI BIOS not configured the device, which may be because -the BIOS has been configured for a "Plug and Play" operating system. -The "Plug and Play OS" setting int he BIOS should be set to "no" or -"off" in order for PCI devices to work properly with FreeBSD. -.It "sf%d: couldn't map ports" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -happen if the PCI BIOS not configured the device, which may be because -the BIOS has been configured for a "Plug and Play" operating system. -The "Plug and Play OS" setting int he BIOS should be set to "no" or -"off" in order for PCI devices to work properly with FreeBSD. -.It "sf%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "sf%d: no memory for softc struct!" -The driver failed to allocate memory for per-device instance information -during initialization. -.It "sf%d: failed to enable I/O ports/memory mapping!" -The driver failed to initialize PCI I/O port or shared memory access. -This might happen if the card is not in a bus-master slot. -.It "sf%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 , -.Rs -.%T The Adaptec AIC-6915 Programmer's Manual -.%O ftp://ftp.adaptec.com/pub/BBS/userguides/aic6915_pg.pdf -.Re -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ctr.columbia.edu . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/si.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/si.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 8f6cc91b87d7..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/si.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,163 +0,0 @@ -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.Dd September 16, 1995 -.Os FreeBSD -.Dt SI 4 i386 -.Sh NAME -.Nm si -.Nd Driver for Specialix International SI/XIO or SX intelligent serial card. -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device si0" -.Cd "device si0 at isa? irq 12 iomem 0xd0000" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The Specialix SI/XIO and SX hardware makes up an 8 to 32 port RS-232 serial -multiplexor. -.Pp -The first instance of the device lines above is for EISA and PCI host cards, -the second is for ISA host cards. -.Pp -The system uses two components: A "Host adapter", which is plugged into -an ISA, EISA or PCI slot and provides intelligence and buffering/processing -capabilities, as well as an external bus in the form of a 37 pin cable. -.Pp -On this cable, "modules" are connected. The "SI" module comes in a 4 and 8 -port version. The "XIO" and "SX" modules come only in -8 port versions. -.Pp -The host adapter polls and transfers data between the modules and the rest -of the machine. The Host adapter provides a 256 byte transmit and 256 byte -receive FIFO for each of the 32 ports that it can maintain. -.Pp -The XIO modules can operate each of their 8 ports at 115,200 baud. -The SI version can run at 57,600 baud. The SX modules can operate each of their -8 ports at up to 921,600 baud. -.Pp -SX modules are only supported when connected to an SX host card. SI or -XIO modules are supported on any host card. -.Pp -The host adapter uses a shared memory block in the traditional ISA bus -"hole" between 0xA0000 and 0xEFFFF. The adapter can be configured outside -range, but requires the memory range to be explicitly non-cached. The -driver does not yet support this mode of operation. -.Pp -SX ISA Host cards have an 8/16 bit mode switch or jumper on them. This switch -or jumper MUST be set for 8 bit mode. -.Pp -The ISA adapters can use Irq's 11, 12 or 15 (and 9 and 10 in the case of -SX host cards). -.Pp -The si device driver may have some of it's configuration settings changed -at run-time with the -.Xr sicontrol 8 -utility. -.Pp -The si device driver also responds to the -.Xr comcontrol 8 -utility for configuring drain-on-close timeouts. -.Pp -The driver also defines 3 sysctl variables that can be manipulated: -machdep.si_debug sets the debug level for the whole driver. It depends -on the driver being compiled with SI_DEBUG. machdep.si_pollrate -sets how often per second the driver polls for lost interrupts. -machdep.si_realpoll sets whether or not the card will treat the -poll intervals as if they were interrupts. -.Pp -An open on a /dev device node controlled by the si driver obeys the same -semantics as the -.Xr sio 4 -driver. It fully supports the usual semantics of the cua ports, and the -"initial termios" and "locked termios" settings. In summary, an open on a -tty port will block until DCD is raised, unless O_NONBLOCK is specified. -CLOCAL is honored. An open on a cua port will always succeed, but DCD -transitions will be honored after DCD rises for the first time. -.Pp -Up to four SI/XIO host cards may be controlled by the si driver. -Due to the lack of available interrupts, only 3 ISA SI/XIO host cards can be -used at once. -.Pp -The lowest 5 bits of the minor device number are used to select the port -number on the module cluster. The next 2 bits select which of 4 host adapter -cards. This allows a maximum of 128 ports on this driver. -.Pp -Bit 7 is used to differentiate a tty/dialin port (bit 7=0) and a -cua/callout port (bit 7=1). -.Pp -Bit 8 through 15 (on -.Tn FreeBSD ) -are unavailable as they are a shadow of the -major device number. -.Pp -If bit 16 is a 1, the device node is referring to the "initial state" device. -This "initial state" is used to prime the -.Xr termios 4 -settings of the device when it is initially opened. -If bit 17 is a 1, the device node is referring to the "locked state" device. -The "locked state" is used to prevent the -.Xr termios 4 -settings from being changed. -.Pp -To manipulate the initial/locked settings, the -.Xr stty 1 -command is useful. When setting the "locked" variables, enabling the mode -on the lock device will lock the termios mode, while disabling the mode will -unlock it. -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width /dev/si_control -compact -.It Pa /dev/si_control -global driver control file for -.Xr sicontrol 8 -.It Pa /dev/ttyA* -terminal/dialin ports -.It Pa /dev/cuaA* -dialout ports -.It Pa /dev/ttyiA* -initial termios state devices -.It Pa /dev/ttylA* -locked termios state devices -.It Pa /dev/cuaiA* -initial termios state devices for dialout ports -.It Pa /dev/cualA* -locked termios state devices for dialout ports -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr stty 1 , -.Xr sio 4 , -.Xr termios 4 , -.Xr tty 4 , -.Xr comcontrol 8 , -.Xr sicontrol 8 -.Sh HISTORY -This driver is loosely based on driver code originating at Specialix, which -was ported to run on BSDI by -.An Andy Rutter Aq andy@specialix.co.uk . -The System V driver source is/was available by ftp from -.Sy ftp.specialix.co.uk . -.Pp -This driver is not supported by Specialix International. -.Sh AUTHORS -.An Peter Wemm Aq peter@netplex.com.au -obtained the code from -.An Andy Rutter -and ported it to -.Fx -and threw the man page together. -.An Bruce Evans Aq bde@zeta.org.au -provided a large amount of assistance during porting. -.An Nick Sayer Aq nick@specialix.com -wrote the EISA, PCI and SX portions. -.Sh BUGS -The interrupt tuning rate is not believed to be optimal at this time for -maximum efficiency. -.Pp -Polled mode (a feature of standard Specialix drivers) is not implemented, -but it can be approximated by turning on machdep.si_realpoll. The poll -frequency is set by machdep.si_pollrate (in units of 1/100th of a second). -.Pp -The driver does not yet support baud rates higher than 115,200 on SX -modules. -.Pp -Operation outside the traditional ISA "hole" is not yet supported, although it -should work if the test is removed from the probe routine. -.Pp -Multiple host cards are supported although combinations of hosts on -different bus types have not been tested - device numbering is known to -be a problem and may lead to unexpected results. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sio.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sio.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 580c5821f711..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sio.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,324 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1991 The Regents of the University of California. -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by -.\" the Systems Programming Group of the University of Utah Computer -.\" Science Department. -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by the University of -.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE -.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL -.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS -.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) -.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT -.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY -.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF -.\" SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" from: @(#)dca.4 5.2 (Berkeley) 3/27/91 -.\" from: com.4,v 1.1 1993/08/06 11:19:07 cgd Exp -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd October 10, 1995 -.Dt SIO 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm sio -.Nd -fast interrupt driven asynchronous serial communications interface -.Sh SYNOPSIS -For standard ports: -.Cd "device sio0 at isa? port" \&"IO_COM1\&" irq 4 -.Cd "device sio1 at isa? port" \&"IO_COM2\&" irq 3 -.Cd "device sio2 at isa? port" \&"IO_COM3\&" irq 5 -.Cd "device sio3 at isa? port" \&"IO_COM4\&" irq 9 -.Pp -For AST compatible multiport cards with 4 ports: -.Cd "options" \&"COM_MULTIPORT\&" -.Cd "device sio4 at isa? port 0x2a0 flags 0x701" -.Cd "device sio5 at isa? port 0x2a8 flags 0x701" -.Cd "device sio6 at isa? port 0x2b0 flags 0x701" -.Cd "device sio7 at isa? port 0x2b8 flags 0x701 irq 12" -.Pp -For Boca Board compatible multiport cards with 8 ports: -.Cd "options" \&"COM_MULTIPORT\&" -.Cd "device sio4 at isa? port 0x100 flags 0xb05" -.Cd "..." -.Cd "device sio11 at isa? port 0x138 flags 0xb05 irq 12" -.Pp -For Hayes ESP cards: -.Cd "options" \&"COM_ESP\&" -.Cd "..." -.Pp -Meaning of -.Ar flags : -.Bl -tag -offset indent -compact -width 0x000000 -.It 0x00001 -shared IRQs -.It 0x00002 -disable FIFO -.It 0x00004 -no AST/4 compatible IRQ control register -.It 0x00008 -recover sooner from lost output interrupts -.It 0x00010 -device is potential system console -.It 0x00020 -device is forced to become system console -.It 0x00040 -device is reserved for low-level IO (e. g. for remote kernel debugging) -.It 0x00080 -use this port for remote kernel debugging -.It 0x0 Ns Em ?? Ns 00 -minor number of master port -.It 0x20000 -device is assumed to use a 16650A-type (extended FIFO) chip -.El -.Pp -Minor numbering: -.br -0b\fIOLIMMMMM\fR -.br - call\fBO\fRut -.br - \fBL\fRock -.br - \fBI\fRnitial -.br - \fBMMMMMM\fRinor -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm sio -driver provides support for NS8250-, NS16450-, NS16550 and NS16550A-based -.Tn EIA -.Tn RS-232C -.Pf ( Tn CCITT -.Tn V.24 ) -communications interfaces. The NS8250 and NS16450 have single character -buffers, the NS16550A has 16 character FIFO input and output buffers. -.Pp -Input and output for each line may set to one of following baud rates; -50, 75, 110, 134.5, 150, 300, 600, 1200, 1800, 2400, 4800, 9600, -19200, 38400, 57600, or 115200. Your hardware may limit your baud -rate choices. -.Pp -The driver supports `multiport' cards. -Multiport cards are those that have one or more groups of ports -that share an Interrupt Request (IRQ) line per group. -Shared IRQs on different cards are not supported. -Frequently 4 ports share 1 IRQ; some 8 port cards have 2 groups of 4 ports, -thus using 2 IRQs. -Some cards allow the first 2 serial ports to have separate IRQs per port -(as per DOS PC standard). -.Pp -Some cards have an IRQ control register for each group. -Some cards require special initialization related to such registers. -Only AST/4 compatible IRQ control registers are supported. -Some cards have an IRQ status register for each group. -The driver does not require or use such registers yet. -To work, the control and status registers for a group, if any, -must be mapped to the scratch register (register 7) -of a port in the group. -Such a port is called a -.Em master -port. -.Pp -The -.Em flags -keyword may be used on each -.Em device sio -line in the kernel configuration file -to disable the FIFO on 16550A UARTs -(see the synopsis). -Disabling the FIFO should rarely be necessary. -.Pp -The -.Em flags -keyword -.Em must -be used for all ports that are part of an IRQ sharing group. -One bit specifies IRQ sharing; another bit specifies whether the port does -.Em not -require AST/4 compatible initialization. -The minor number of the device corresponding a master port -for the group is encoded as a bitfield in the high byte. -The same master port must be specified for all ports in a group. -.Pp -The -.Em irq -specification must be given for master ports -and for ports that are not part of an IRQ sharing group, -and not for other ports. -.Pp -In the synopsis, -.Em flags 0x701 -means that the 8th port (sio7) is the master -port, and that the port is on a multiport card with shared IRQs -and an AST/4 compatible IRQ control register. -.Pp -.Em flags 0xb05 -means that the 12th port (sio11) is the master -port, and that the port is on a multiport card with shared IRQs -and no special IRQ control register. -.Pp -Which port is the master port depends on the card type. -Consult the hardware documentation of your card. -Since IRQ status registers are never used, -and IRQ control registers are only used for AST/4 compatible cards, -and some cards map the control/status registers to all ports in a group, -any port in a group will sometimes do for the master port. -Choose a port containing an IRQ status register for forwards compatibility, -and the highest possible port for consistency. -.Pp -Serial ports controlled by the -.Nm sio -driver can be used for both `callin' and `callout'. -For each port there is a callin device and a callout device. -The minor number of the callout device is 128 higher -than that of the corresponding callin port. -The callin device is general purpose. -Processes opening it normally wait for carrier -and for the callout device to become inactive. -The callout device is used to steal the port from -processes waiting for carrier on the callin device. -Processes opening it do not wait for carrier -and put any processes waiting for carrier on the callin device into -a deeper sleep so that they do not conflict with the callout session. -The callout device is abused for handling programs that are supposed -to work on general ports and need to open the port without waiting -but are too stupid to do so. -.Pp -The -.Nm sio -driver also supports an initial-state and a lock-state control -device for each of the callin and the callout "data" devices. -The minor number of the initial-state device is 32 higher -than that of the corresponding data device. -The minor number of the lock-state device is 64 higher -than that of the corresponding data device. -The termios settings of a data device are copied -from those of the corresponding initial-state device -on first opens and are not inherited from previous opens. -Use -.Xr stty 1 -in the normal way on the initial-state devices to program -initial termios states suitable for your setup. -.Pp -The lock termios state acts as flags to disable changing -the termios state. E.g., to lock a flag variable such as -CRTSCTS, use -.Em stty crtscts -on the lock-state device. Speeds and special characters -may be locked by setting the corresponding value in the lock-state -device to any nonzero value. -.Pp -Correct programs talking to correctly wired external devices -work with almost arbitrary initial states and almost no locking, -but other setups may benefit from changing some of the default -initial state and locking the state. -In particular, the initial states for non (POSIX) standard flags -should be set to suit the devices attached and may need to be -locked to prevent buggy programs from changing them. -E.g., CRTSCTS should be locked on for devices that support -RTS/CTS handshaking at all times and off for devices that don't -support it at all. CLOCAL should be locked on for devices -that don't support carrier. HUPCL may be locked off if you don't -want to hang up for some reason. In general, very bad things happen -if something is locked to the wrong state, and things should not -be locked for devices that support more than one setting. The -CLOCAL flag on callin ports should be locked off for logins -to avoid certain security holes, but this needs to be done by -getty if the callin port is used for anything else. -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width /dev/ttyid? -compact -.It Pa /dev/ttyd? -for callin ports -.It Pa /dev/ttyid? -.It Pa /dev/ttyld? -corresponding callin initial-state and lock-state devices -.Pp -.It Pa /dev/cuaa? -for callout ports -.It Pa /dev/cuaia? -.It Pa /dev/cuala? -corresponding callout initial-state and lock-state devices -.El -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width /etc/rc.serial -compact -.It Pa /etc/rc.serial -examples of setting the initial-state and lock-state devices -.El -.Pp -The devices numbers are made from the set [0-9a-v] so that more than -10 ports can be supported. -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It sio%d: silo overflow. -Problem in the interrupt handler. -.El -.Bl -diag -.It sio%d: interrupt-level buffer overflow. -Problem in the bottom half of the driver. -.El -.Bl -diag -.It sio%d: tty-level buffer overflow. -Problem in the application. -Input has arrived faster than the given module could process it -and some has been lost. -.El -.\" .Bl -diag -.\" .It sio%d: reduced fifo trigger level to %d. -.\" Attempting to avoid further silo overflows. -.\" .El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr stty 1 , -.Xr termios 4 , -.Xr tty 4 , -.Xr comcontrol 8 -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -driver is derived from the -.Tn HP9000/300 -.Xr dca 4 -driver and is -.Ud -.Sh BUGS -Data loss may occur at very high baud rates on slow systems, -or with too many ports on any system, -or on heavily loaded systems when crtscts cannot be used. -The use of NS16550A's reduces system load and helps to avoid data loss. -.Pp -Stay away from plain NS16550's. These are early -implementations of the chip with non-functional FIFO hardware. -.Pp -The constants which define the locations -of the various serial ports are holdovers from -.Tn DOS . -As shown, hex addresses can be and for clarity probably should be used instead. -.Pp -Note that on the AST/4 the card's dipswitches should -.Em not -be set to use interrupt sharing. AST/4-like interrupt sharing is only used when -.Em multiple -AST/4 cards are installed in the same system. The sio driver does not -support more than 1 AST/4 on one IRQ. -.Pp -The examples in the synopsis are too vendor-specific. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sis.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sis.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 47a257920ceb..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sis.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,149 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998, 1999 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd September 4, 1999 -.Dt SIS 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm sis -.Nd -Silicon Integrated Systems fast ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "controller miibus0" -.Cd "device sis0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI ethernet adapters and embedded -controllers based on the Silicon Integrated Systems SiS 900 -and SiS 7016 fast ethernet controller chips. -.Pp -The SiS 900 is a 100Mbps ethernet MAC and MII-compliant transceiver -in a single package. It uses a bus master DMA and a scatter/gather -descriptor scheme. The SiS 7016 is similar to the SiS 900 except -that it has no internal PHY, requiring instead an external transceiver -to be attached to its MII interface. -The SiS 900 and SiS 7016 both have a 128-bit multicast hash filter -and a single perfect filter entry for the station address. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. -The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -fine. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "sis%d: couldn't map ports/memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "sis%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "sis%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.It "sis%d: no memory for rx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the receiver ring. -.It "sis%d: no memory for tx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the transmitter ring when -allocating a pad buffer or collapsing an mbuf chain into a clusisr. -.It "sis%d: chip is in D3 power state -- setting to D0" -This message applies only to adapters which support power -management. Some operating sysisms place the controller in low power -mode when shutting down, and some PCI BIOSes fail to bring the chip -out of this state before configuring it. The controller loses all of -its PCI configuration in the D3 state, so if the BIOS does not set -it back to full power mode in time, it won't be able to configure it -correctly. The driver tries to detect this condition and bring -the adapter back to the D0 (full power) state, but this may not be -enough to return the driver to a fully operational condition. If -you see this message at boot time and the driver fails to attach -the device as a network interface, you will have to perform second -warm boot to have the device properly configured. -.Pp -Note that this condition only occurs when warm booting from another -operating sysism. If you power down your sysism prior to booting -.Fx , -the card should be configured correctly. -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Rs -.%T SiS 900 and SiS 7016 datasheets -.%O http://www.sis.com.tw -.Re -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ee.columbia.edu . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sk.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sk.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 5fc826e6f34c..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sk.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,159 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998, 1999 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd July 3, 1999 -.Dt SK 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm sk -.Nd -SysKonnect SK-984x PCI gigabit ethernet adapter driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device sk0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for the SysKonnect SK-984x series PCI -gigabit ethernet adapters, including the following: -.Bl -bullet -offset indent -.It -SK-9841 SK-NET GE-LX single port, single mode fiber adapter -.It -SK-9842 SK-NET GE-SX single port, multimode fiber adapter -.It -SK-9843 SK-NET GE-LX dual port, single mode fiber adapter -.It -SK-9844 SK-NET GE-SX duak port, multimode fiber adapter -.El -.Pp -The SysKonnect adapters consist of two main components: the XaQti Corp. -XMAC II gigabit MAC and the SysKonnect GEnesis controller ASIC. The -XMAC provides the gigabit MAC and PHY suspport while the GEnesis -provides an interface to the PCI bus, DMA support, packet buffering -and arbitration. The GEnesis can control up to two XMACs simultaneously, -allowing dual-port NIC configurations. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver configures dual port SysKonnect adapters such that each XMAC -is treated as a separate logical network interface. Both ports can -operate indepenently of each other and can be connected to separate -networks. The SysKonnect driver software currently only uses the -second port on dual port adapters for failover purposes: if the link -on the primary port fails, the SysKonnect driver will automatically -switch traffic onto the second port. -.Pp -The XaQti XMAC II supports full and half duplex operation with -autonegotiation. The XMAC also supports unlimited frame sizes. -Support for jumbo frames is provided via the interface MTU setting. -Selecting an MTU larger than 1500 bytes with the -.Xr ifconfig 8 -utility configures the adapter to receive and transmit jumbo frames. -Using jumbo frames can greatly improve performance for certain tasks, -such as file transfers and data streaming. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. -The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -file. -.It 1000baseSX -Set 1000Mbps (gigabit ethernet) operation. Both -.Ar full-duplex -and -.Ar half-duplex -modes are supported. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "sk%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "sk%d: couldn't map ports" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "sk%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "sk%d: no memory for softc struct!" -The driver failed to allocate memory for per-device instance information -during initialization. -.It "sk%d: failed to enable memory mapping!" -The driver failed to initialize PCI shared memory mapping. This might -happen if the card is not in a bus-master slot. -.It "sk%d: no memory for jumbo buffers!" -The driver failed to allocate memory for jumbo frames during -initialization. -.It "sk%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr vlan 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Rs -.%T XaQti XMAC II datasheet -.%O http://www.xaqti.com -.Re -.Rs -.%T SysKonnect GEnesis programming manual -.%O http://www.syskonnect.com -.Re -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ctr.columbia.edu . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/splash.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/splash.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 640964527990..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/splash.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,242 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1999 -.\" Kazutaka YOKOTA -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer as -.\" the first lines of this file unmodified. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd February 9, 1999 -.Dt SPLASH 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm splash -.Nd -splash screen / screen saver interface -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "pseudo-device splash" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -pseudo device driver adds support for the splash screen and screen -savers to the kernel. -This driver is required if the splash bitmap image is to be loaded or -any screen saver is to be used. -.Sh SPLASH SCREEN -You can load and display an arbitrary bitmap image file as welcome banner -on the screen when the system is about to start. This image will remain on -the screen during kernel initialization process until the ``Login'' prompt -appears on the screen or until a screen saver is loaded and initialized. -The image will also disappear if you hit any key, although this may not work -immediately if the kernel is still probing devices. -.Pp -If you specify -.Fl c -or -.Fl v -boot option when loading kernel, the splash image will not appear. However, it -is still loaded and can be used as a screen saver later: see below. -.Pp -In order to display the bitmap, the bitmap file itself and the -matching splash image decoder module must be loaded by the boot loader. -Currently the following decoder module is available: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width splash_decoder -compact -.It Pa splash_bmp.ko -W*ndows BMP file decoder. -While the BMP file format allows images of various color depths, this -decoder currently only handles 256 color bitmaps. Bitmaps of other color -depths will not be displayed. -.It Pa splash_pcx.ko -ZSoft PCX decoder. -This decoder currently only supports version 5 8-bpp single-plane -images. -.El -.Pp -The -.Sx EXAMPLES -section illustrates how to set up the splash screen. -.Pp -If the standard VGA video mode is used, -the size of the bitmap must be 320x200 or less. -If you enable the VESA mode support in the kernel, -either by statically linking the VESA module or by loading the VESA module -.Pq see Xr vga 4 , -you can load bitmaps up to a resolution of 1024x768, depending on the VESA -BIOS and the amount of video memory on the video card. -.Sh SCREEN SAVER -The screen saver will activate when the system is considered idle: i.e. -when the user has not typed a key or moved the mouse for a specified period -of time. As the screen saver is an optional module, it must be explicitly -loaded into memory. Currently the following screen saver modules are -available: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width splash_module.ko -compact -.It Pa blank_saver.ko -This screen saver simply blanks the screen. -.It Pa daemon_saver.ko -Animated BSD Daemon screen saver. -.It Pa fade_saver.ko -The screen will gradually fade away. -.It Pa green_saver.ko -If the monitor supports power saving mode, it will be turned off. -.It Pa logo_saver.ko -Animated graphical BSD Daemon. -.It Pa rain_saver.ko -Draws shower on the screen. -.It Pa snake_saver.ko -Draws a snake of string. -.It Pa star_saver.ko -Twinkling stars. -.It Pa warp_saver.ko -Streaking stars. -.El -.Pp -Screen saver modules can be loaded using -.Xr kldload 8 : -.Pp -.Dl kldload logo_saver -.Pp -The timeout value in seconds can be specified as follows: -.Pp -.Dl vidcontrol -t N -.Pp -Alternatively, you can set the -.Ar saver -variable in the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -to the screen saver of your choice and -the timeout value to the -.Ar blanktime -variable so that the screen saver is automatically loaded -and the timeout value is set when the system starts. -.Pp -The screen saver may be instantly activated by hitting the -.Ar saver -key: the defaults are -.Em Shift-Pause - on the AT enhanced keyboard and -.Em Shift-Ctrl-NumLock/Pause -on the AT 84 keyboard. You can change the -.Ar saver -key by modifying the keymap -.Pq see Xr kbdcontrol 1 , Xr keymap 5 , -and assign the -.Ar saver -function to a key of your preference. -.Pp -The screen saver will not run if the screen is not in text mode. -.Sh SPLASH SCREEN AS A SCREEN SAVER -If you load a splash image but do not load a screen saver, -you can continue using the splash module as a screen saver. -The screen blanking interval can be specified as described in the -.Sx SCREEN SAVER -section above. -.\".Sh DRIVER CONFIGURATION -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width /modules/splash_xxxx.ko -compact -.It /boot/defaults/loader.conf -boot loader configuration defaults -.It /etc/rc.conf -system configuration information -.It /modules/splash_*.ko -splash image decoder modules -.It /modules/*_saver.ko -screen saver modules -.It /modules/vesa.ko -the VESA support module -.El -.Sh EXAMPLE -In order to load the splash screen or the screen saver, you must -have the following line in the kernel configuration file. -.Pp -.Dl pseudo-device splash -.Pp -Next, edit -.Pa /boot/loader.conf -.Pq see Xr loader.conf 5 -and include the following lines: -.Bd -literal -offset indent -splash_bmp_load="YES" -bitmap_load="YES" -bitmap_name="chuck.bmp" -.Ed -.Pp -In the above example, the file -.Pa chuck.bmp -is loaded. -In the following example, the VESA module -is loaded so that a bitmap file which cannot be displayed in standard -VGA modes may be shown using one of the VESA video modes. -.Bd -literal -offset indent -splash_pcx_load="YES" -vesa_load="YES" -bitmap_load="YES" -bitmap_name="chuck.pcx" -.Ed -.Pp -If the VESA support is statically linked to the kernel, it is not -necessary to load the VESA module. -Just load the bitmap file and the splash decoder module as in the -first example above. -.\".Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Sh CAVEATS -Both the splash screen and the screen saver work with -.Xr syscons 4 -only. They are not available for the alternative console driver -.Xr pcvt 4 . -.Sh BUGS -If you load a screen saver while another screen saver has already -been loaded, the first screen saver will not be automatically unloaded -and will remain in memory, wasting kernel memory space. -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr vidcontrol 1 , -.Xr syscons 4 , -.Xr vga 4 , -.Xr loader.conf 5 , -.Xr rc.conf 5 , -.Xr kldload 8 , -.Xr kldunload 8 . -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.1 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver and this manual page were written by -.An Kazutaka Yokota Aq yokota@FreeBSD.org . -The -.Pa splash_bmp -module was written by -.An Michael Smith Aq msmith@FreeBSD.org -and -.An Kazutaka Yokota . -The -.Pa splash_pcx -module was written by -.An Dag-Erling Smørgrav Aq des@FreeBDS.org -based on the -.Pa splash_bmp -code. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ste.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ste.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 3da3895c54a4..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ste.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,149 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998, 1999 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd August 21, 1999 -.Dt STE 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm ste -.Nd -Sundance Technologies ST201 fast ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "controller miibus0" -.Cd "device ste0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI ethernet adapters and embedded -controllers based on the Sundance Technologies ST201 PCI fast -ethernet controller chip. This includes the D-Link DFE-550TX. -.Pp -The Sundance ST201 uses bus master DMA and is designed to be a -3Com Etherlink XL workalike. It uses the same DMA descriptor -structure and is very similar in operation, however its register -layout is different. The ST201 has a 64-bit multicast hash filter -and a single perfect filter entry for the station address. IT -supports both 10 and 100Mbps speeds in either full or half duplex -using an MII transceiver. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. -The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -fine. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "ste%d: couldn't map ports/memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "ste%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "ste%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.It "ste%d: no memory for rx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the receiver ring. -.It "ste%d: no memory for tx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the transmitter ring when -allocating a pad buffer or collapsing an mbuf chain into a cluster. -.It "ste%d: chip is in D3 power state -- setting to D0" -This message applies only to adapters which support power -management. Some operating systems place the controller in low power -mode when shutting down, and some PCI BIOSes fail to bring the chip -out of this state before configuring it. The controller loses all of -its PCI configuration in the D3 state, so if the BIOS does not set -it back to full power mode in time, it won't be able to configure it -correctly. The driver tries to detect this condition and bring -the adapter back to the D0 (full power) state, but this may not be -enough to return the driver to a fully operational condition. If -you see this message at boot time and the driver fails to attach -the device as a network interface, you will have to perform second -warm boot to have the device properly configured. -.Pp -Note that this condition only occurs when warm booting from another -operating system. If you power down your system prior to booting -.Fx , -the card should be configured correctly. -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Rs -.%T Sundance ST201 data sheet -.%O http://www.sundanceti.com -.Re -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ee.columbia.edu . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/syscons.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/syscons.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 48b9d85f1b40..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/syscons.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,495 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1999 -.\" Kazutaka YOKOTA -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer as -.\" the first lines of this file unmodified. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd June 30, 1999 -.Dt SYSCONS 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm syscons , -.Nm sc -.Nd -the console driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "options MAXCONS=N" -.Cd "options SC_ALT_MOUSE_IMAGE" -.Cd "options SC_DISABLE_DDBKEY" -.Cd "options SC_DISABLE_REBOOT" -.Cd "options SC_HISTORY_SIZE=N" -.Cd "options SC_MOUSE_CHAR=C" -.Cd "options SC_NO_CUTPASTE" -.Cd "options SC_NO_FONT_LOADING" -.Cd "options SC_NO_HISTORY" -.Cd "options SC_NO_PALETTE_LOADING" -.Cd "options SC_NO_SYSMOUSE" -.Cd "options SC_PIXEL_MODE" -.Cd "options SC_TWOBUTTON_MOUSE -.Cd "options SC_NORM_ATTR"=\&"_attribute_\&" -.Cd "options SC_NORM_REV_ATTR"=\&"_attribute_\&" -.Cd "options SC_KERNEL_CONS_ATTR"=\&"_attribute_\&" -.Cd "options SC_KERNEL_CONS_REV_ATTR"=\&"_attribute_\&" -.Cd "options SC_DFLT_FONT" -.Cd "makeoptions SC_DFLT_FONT"=\&"_font_name_\&" -.Cd "device sc0 at isa?" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides multiple virtual terminals. -It resembles the SCO color console driver. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver is implemented on top of the keyboard driver -.Pq Xr atkbd 4 -and the video card driver -.Pq Xr vga 4 -and so requires both of them to be configured in the system. -.Pp -There can be only one -.Nm -device defined in the system. -.Ss Virtual Terminals -The -.Nm -driver provides multiple virtual terminals which appear as if they were -separate terminals. -One virtual terminal is considered current and exclusively -occupies the screen and the keyboard; the other virtual terminals -are placed in the background. -.Pp -In order to use virtual terminals, they must be individually -marked ``on'' in -.Pa /etc/ttys -so that -.Xr getty 8 -will recognize them to be active and run -.Xr login 1 -to let the user to login to the system. -By default, only the first eight virtual terminals are activated in -.Pa /etc/ttys . -.Pp -You press the -.Em Alt -key and a switch key to switch between -virtual terminals. -The following table summarizes the correspondence between the switch -key and the virtual terminal. -.Bd -literal -offset indent -Alt-F1 ttyv0 Alt-F7 ttyv6 Shift-Alt-F1 ttyv10 -Alt-F2 ttyv1 Alt-F8 ttyv7 Shift-Alt-F2 ttyv11 -Alt-F3 ttyv2 Alt-F9 ttyv8 Shift-Alt-F3 ttyv12 -Alt-F4 ttyv3 Alt-F10 ttyv9 Shift-Alt-F4 ttyv13 -Alt-F5 ttyv4 Alt-F11 ttyv10 Shift-Alt-F5 ttyv14 -Alt-F6 ttyv5 Alt-F12 ttyv11 Shift-Alt-F6 ttyv15 -.Ed -.Pp -You can also use the ``nscr'' key (usually the -.Em PrintScreen -key on the AT Enhanced keyboard) to cycle available virtual terminals. -.Pp -The default number of available virtual terminals is 16. -This can be changed by the kernel configuration option -.Em MAXCONS -(see below). -.Pp -Note that the X server usually requires a virtual terminal for display -purposes, so at least one terminal must be left unused by -.Xr getty 8 -so that it can be used by the X server. -.Ss Key Definitions and Function Key Strings -The -.Nm -driver, in conjunction with the keyboard driver, allows the user -to change key definitions and function key strings. -The -.Xr kbdcontrol 1 -command will load a key definition file (known as ``keymap'' file), -dump the current keymap, and assign a string to a function key. -See -.Xr keyboard 4 -and -.Xr keymap 5 -for the keymap file. -.Pp -You may want to set the -.Ar keymap -variable in -.Pa /etc/rc.conf.local -to the desired keymap file so that it will be automatically loaded -when the system starts up. -.Ss Software Font -For most modern video cards, e.g. VGA, the -.Nm -driver and the video card driver allow the user to change -the font used on the screen. -The -.Xr vidcontrol 1 -command can be used to load a font file from -.Pa /usr/share/syscons/fonts . -.Pp -The font comes in various sizes: 8x8, 8x14 and 8x16. -The 8x16 font is typically used for the VGA card in the 80-column- -by-25-line mode. -Other video modes may require different size of font. -It is better to always load these three sizes of the same font. -.Pp -You may set -.Ar font8x8 , -.Ar font8x14 -and -.Ar font8x16 -variables in -.Pa /etc/rc.conf.local -to the desired font files so that they will be automatically loaded -when the system starts up. -.Pp -Optionally you can make a particular font file as the default font. -See the -.Em SC_DFLT_FONT -option below. -.Ss Screen Map -If your video card does not support software font, you may still be able -to have similar effect by re-mapping font hard-wired in the video card. -Use -.Xr vidcontrol 1 -to load a screen map file which defines mapping between character codes. -.Ss Mouse Support and Copy-and-Paste -You can use your mouse to copy text on the screen and paste it as if -it is typed by hand. -You must be running the mouse daemon -.Xr moused 8 -and enable the mouse cursor in the virtual terminal via -.Xr vidcontrol 1 . -.Pp -Pressing the mouse button 1 (usually the left button) will start selection. -Releasing the button 1 will end the selection process. -The selected text will be marked by inverting foreground and -background colors. -You can press the button 3 (usually the right button) to extend -the selected region. -The selected text is placed in the copy buffer and can be pasted -at the cursor position by your pressing the button 2 (usually the -middle button) as many times as you like. -.Pp -If your mouse has only two buttons, you may want to use the -.Em SC_TWOBUTTON_MOUSE -option below to make the right button to paste the text. -Alternatively you can make the mouse daemon -to emulate the middle button. -See the man page for -.Xr moused 8 -for more details. -.Ss Back Scrolling -The -.Nm -driver allows the user to browse the output which has ``scrolled off'' -from the top of the screen. -.Pp -Press the ``slock'' key (usually -.Em ScrllLock -and/or -.Em Pause -keys on many AT Enhanced keyboards) and the terminal is -in the ``back scrolling'' mode. -It is indicated by the -.Em Scroll Lock -LED. -Use arrow keys, -.Em Page Up/Down -keys and -.Em Home/End -keys to scroll buffered terminal output. -Press the ``slock'' key again to get back to the normal terminal mode. -.Pp -The size of the back-scroll buffer can be set by the -.Em SC_HISTORY_SIZE -option below. -.Ss Screen Saver -The -.Nm -driver can be made to put up the screen saver if the current -virtual terminal is idle, that is, the user is not typing -on the keyboard nor moving mouse. -See -.Xr splash 4 -and -.Xr vidcontrol 1 -for more details. -.Sh DRIVER CONFIGURATION -.Ss Kernel Configuration Options -The following kernel configuration options control the -.Nm -driver. -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE -.It Em MAXCONS=N -This option sets the number of virtual terminals to -.Fa N . -The default value is 16. -.It Em SC_ALT_MOUSE_IMAGE -This option selects the alternative way of displaying the mouse cursor -in the virtual terminal. -It may be vastly costly for some video cards to draw the arrow-shaped -cursor and you may want to try this option. -However, the appearance of the alternative mouse cursor may not be -very appealing. -.It Em SC_DISABLE_DDBKEY -This option disables the ``debug'' key (by default, it is -.Em Alt-Esc , -or -.Em Ctl-PrintScreen -). -It will prevent the user from -entering the kernel debugger DDB by pressing the key combination. -DDB will still be invoked when the kernel panics or hits a break point -if it is included in the kernel. -.It Em SC_DISABLE_REBOOT -This option disables the ``reboot'' key (by default, it is -.Em Ctl-Alt-Del -), so that the casual user may not accidentally reboot the system. -.It Em SC_HISTORY_SIZE=N -Sets the size of back scroll buffer to -.Fa N -lines. -The default value is 100. -.It Em SC_MOUSE_CHAR=C -Unless the -.Em SC_ALT_MOUSE_IMAGE -option above is specified, the -The -.Nm -driver reserves four consecutive character codes in order to display the -mouse cursor in the virtual terminals in some systems. -This option specifies the first character code to -.Fa C -to be used for this purpose. -The default value is 0xd0. -A good candidate is 0x03. -.It Em SC_PIXEL_MODE -Adds support for pixel (raster) mode console. -This mode is useful on some laptop computers, but less so on -most other systems, and it adds substantial amount of code to syscons. -If the this option is NOT defined, you can reduce the kernel size a lot. -See the -.Em VESA800X600 -flag below. -.It Em SC_TWOBUTTON_MOUSE -If you have a two button mouse, you may want to add this option -to use the right button of the mouse to paste text. -See -.Sx Mouse Support and Copy-and-Paste -above. -.It Em SC_NORM_ATTR=\&"_attribute_\&" -.It Em SC_NORM_REV_ATTR=\&"_attribute_\&" -.It Em SC_KERNEL_CONS_ATTR=\&"_attribute_\&" -.It Em SC_KERNEL_CONS_REV_ATTR=\&"_attribute_\&" -These options will set the default colors. -Available colors are defined in -.Pa /usr/include/machine/pc/display.h . -See -.Sx EXAMPLE -below. -.It Em SC_DFLT_FONT -This option will specify the default font. -Available fonts are: iso, iso2, koi8-r, cp437, cp850, cp865 and cp866. -16-line, 14-line and 8-line font data will be compiled in. -Without this option, the -.Nm -driver will use whatever font already loaded in the video card, -unless you explicitly load software font at startup. -See -.Sx EXAMPLE -below. -.El -.Pp -The following options will remove some features from the -.Nm -driver and save kernel memory. -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE -.It Em SC_NO_CUTPASTE -This option disables ``copy and paste'' operation in virtual -terminals. -.It Em SC_NO_FONT_LOADING -The -.Nm -driver can load software font on some video cards. -This option removes this feature. -.It Em SC_NO_HISTORY -This option disables back-scrolling in virtual terminals. -.\".It Em SC_NO_PALETTE_LOADING -.It Em SC_NO_SYSMOUSE -This option removes mouse support in the -.Nm -driver. -The mouse daemon -.Xr moused 8 -will fail if this option is defined. -This option implies the -.Em SC_NO_CUTPASTE -option too. -.El -.Ss Driver Flags -The following driver flags can be used to control the -.Nm -driver. -They can be set either in the kernel configuration file -.Pq see Xr config 8 , -or else in the User Configuration Menu at boot -time -.Pq see Xr boot 8 . -.Bl -tag -width bit_0 -.\".It bit 0 (VISUAL_BELL) -.\"Uses the ``visual'' bell. -.\"The screen will blink instead of generating audible sound. -.\".It bit 1,2 (CURSOR_TYPE) -.\"This option specifies the cursor appearance. -.\"Possible values are: -.\".Bl -tag -width TYPE -compact -.\".It Em 0 -.\"normal block cursor -.\".It Em 2 -.\"blinking block cursor -.\".It Em 4 -.\"underline cursor -.\".It Em 6 -.\"blinking underline (aka destructive) cursor -.\".El -.\".It bit 6 (QUIET_BELL) -.\"This option suppresses the bell, whether audible or visual, -.\"if it is rung in a background virtual terminal. -.It bit 7 (VESA800X600) -This option puts the video card in the VESA 800x600 dots, 16 color -mode. -It may be useful for laptop computers for which the 800x600 mode -is otherwise unsupported by the X server. -Note that in order for this flag to work, the kernel must be -compiled with the -.Em SC_PIXEL_MODE -option explained above. -.\"Note also that the ``copy-and-paste'' function is not currently supported -.\"in this mode and the mouse pointer will not be displayed. -.El -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width /usr/share/syscons/xxxxyyyyzzz -compact -.It Pa /dev/console -.It Pa /dev/consolectl -.It Pa /dev/ttyv? -virtual terminals -.It Pa /etc/ttys -terminal initialization information -.It Pa /usr/share/syscons/fonts/* -font files -.It Pa /usr/share/syscons/keymaps/* -key map files -.It Pa /usr/share/syscons/scrmaps/* -screen map files -.El -.Sh EXAMPLE -As the -.Nm -driver requires the keyboard driver and the video card driver, -the kernel configuration file should contain the following lines. -.Pp -.Bd -literal -offset indent -device atkbdc0 at isa? port IO_KBD -device atkbd0 at atkbdc? irq 1 -device vga0 at isa? conflicts -device sc0 at isa? - -pseudo-device splash -.Ed -.Pp -If you do not intend to load the splash image or use the screen saver, -the last line is not necessary, and can be omitted. -.Pp -Note that the keyboard controller driver -.Nm atkbdc -is required by the keyboard driver -.Nm atkbd . -.Pp -The following lines will set the default colors. -The normal text will be green on black background. -The reversed text will be yellow on green background. -Note that you cannot put any white space inside the quoted string, -because of the current implementation of -.Xr config 8 . -.Pp -.Dl "options SC_NORM_ATTR"=\&"(FG_GREEN|BG_BLACK)\&" -.Dl "options SC_NORM_REV_ATTR"=\&"(FG_YELLOW|BG_GREEN)\&" -.Pp -The following lines will set the default colors of the kernel message. -The kernel message will be printed bright red on black background. -The reversed message will be black on red background. -.Pp -.Dl "options SC_KERNEL_CONS_ATTR"=\&"(FG_LIGHTRED|BG_BLACK)\&" -.Dl "options SC_KERNEL_CONS_REV_ATTR"=\&"(FG_BLACK|BG_RED)\&" -.Pp -The following example adds the font files -.Pa cp850-8x16.fnt , -.Pa cp850-8x14.font -and -.Pa cp850-8x8.font -to the kernel. -.Pp -.Dl "options SC_DFLT_FONT" -.Dl "makeoptions SC_DFLT_FONT"=\&"cp850\&" -.Dl "device sc0 at isa? -.Pp -.\".Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.\".Sh CAVEATS -.Sh BUGS -This manual page is incomplete and urgently needs revision. -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr kbdcontrol 1 , -.Xr login 1 , -.Xr vidcontrol 1 , -.Xr atkbd 4 , -.Xr atkbdc 4 , -.Xr keyboard 4 , -.Xr screen 4 , -.Xr splash 4 , -.Xr ukbd 4 , -.Xr vga 4 , -.Xr keymap 5 , -.Xr rc.conf 5 , -.Xr screenmap 5 , -.Xr ttys 5 , -.Xr config 8 , -.Xr getty 8 , -.Xr kldload 8 , -.Xr moused 8 . -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -driver first appeared in -.Fx 1.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Søren Schmidt Aq sos@FreeBSD.org . -This manual page was written by -.An Kazutaka Yokota Aq yokota@FreeBSD.org . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sysmouse.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sysmouse.4 deleted file mode 100644 index dc6e4a4f062a..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/sysmouse.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,463 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997 -.\" John-Mark Gurney. All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY John-Mark Gurney AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE -.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL -.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS -.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) -.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT -.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY -.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF -.\" SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd December 3, 1997 -.Dt SYSMOUSE 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm sysmouse -.\" .Nd supplies mouse data from syscons for other applications -.Nd virtualized mouse driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Fd #include -.Fd #include -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The console driver, in conjunction with the mouse daemon -.Xr moused 8 , -supplies mouse data to the user process in the standardized way via the -.Nm -driver. -This arrangement makes it possible for the console and the user process -.Pq such as the Tn X\ Window System -to share the mouse. -.Pp -The user process which wants to utilize mouse operation simply opens -.Pa /dev/sysmouse -with a -.Xr open 2 -call and reads -mouse data from the device via -.Xr read 2 . -Make sure that -.Xr moused 8 -is running, otherwise the user process won't see any data coming from -the mouse. -.Pp -.Ss Operation Levels -The -.Nm -driver has two levels of operation. -The current operation level can be referred to and changed via ioctl calls. -.Pp -The level zero, the basic level, is the lowest level at which the driver -offers the basic service to user programs. -The -.Nm -driver -provides horizontal and vertical movement of the mouse -and state of up to three buttons in the -.Tn MouseSystems -format as follows. -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width Byte_1 -compact -.It Byte 1 -.Bl -tag -width bit_7 -compact -.It bit 7 -Always one. -.It bit 6..3 -Always zero. -.It bit 2 -Left button status; cleared if pressed, otherwise set. -.It bit 1 -Middle button status; cleared if pressed, otherwise set. Always one, -if the device does not have the middle button. -.It bit 0 -Right button status; cleared if pressed, otherwise set. -.El -.It Byte 2 -The first half of horizontal movement count in two's complement; --128 through 127. -.It Byte 3 -The first half of vertical movement count in two's complement; --128 through 127. -.It Byte 4 -The second half of the horizontal movement count in two's complement; --128 through 127. To obtain the full horizontal movement count, add -the byte 2 and 4. -.It Byte 5 -The second half of the vertical movement count in two's complement; --128 through 127. To obtain the full vertical movement count, add -the byte 3 and 5. -.El -.Pp -At the level one, the extended level, mouse data is encoded -in the standard format -.Dv MOUSE_PROTO_SYSMOUSE -as defined in -.Xr mouse 4 . -.\" .Ss Acceleration -.\" The -.\" .Nm -.\" driver can somewhat `accelerate' the movement of the pointing device. -.\" The faster you move the device, the further the pointer -.\" travels on the screen. -.\" The driver has an internal variable which governs the effect of -.\" the acceleration. Its value can be modified via the driver flag -.\" or via an ioctl call. -.Sh IOCTLS -This section describes two classes of -.Xr ioctl 2 -commands: -commands for the -.Nm -driver itself, and commands for the console and the console control drivers. -.Ss Sysmouse Ioctls -There are a few commands for mouse drivers. -General description of the commands is given in -.Xr mouse 4 . -Followings are the features specific to the -.Nm -driver. -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE -compact -.It Dv MOUSE_GETLEVEL Ar int *level -.It Dv MOUSE_SETLEVEL Ar int *level -These commands manipulate the operation level of the mouse driver. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_GETHWINFO Ar mousehw_t *hw -Returns the hardware information of the attached device in the following -structure. Only the -.Dv iftype -field is guaranteed to be filled with the correct value in the current -version of the -.Nm -driver. -.Bd -literal -typedef struct mousehw { - int buttons; /* number of buttons */ - int iftype; /* I/F type */ - int type; /* mouse/track ball/pad... */ - int model; /* I/F dependent model ID */ - int hwid; /* I/F dependent hardware ID */ -} mousehw_t; -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Dv buttons -field holds the number of buttons detected by the driver. -.Pp -The -.Dv iftype -is always -.Dv MOUSE_IF_SYSMOUSE. -.Pp -The -.Dv type -tells the device type: -.Dv MOUSE_MOUSE , -.Dv MOUSE_TRACKBALL , -.Dv MOUSE_STICK , -.Dv MOUSE_PAD , -or -.Dv MOUSE_UNKNOWN . -.Pp -The -.Dv model -is always -.Dv MOUSE_MODEL_GENERIC -at the operation level 0. -It may be -.Dv MOUSE_MODEL_GENERIC -or one of -.Dv MOUSE_MODEL_XXX -constants at higher operation levels. -.Pp -The -.Dv hwid -is always zero. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_GETMODE Ar mousemode_t *mode -The command gets the current operation parameters of the mouse -driver. -.Bd -literal -typedef struct mousemode { - int protocol; /* MOUSE_PROTO_XXX */ - int rate; /* report rate (per sec) */ - int resolution; /* MOUSE_RES_XXX, -1 if unknown */ - int accelfactor; /* acceleration factor */ - int level; /* driver operation level */ - int packetsize; /* the length of the data packet */ - unsigned char syncmask[2]; /* sync. bits */ -} mousemode_t; -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Dv protocol -field tells the format in which the device status is returned -when the mouse data is read by the user program. -It is -.Dv MOUSE_PROTO_MSC -at the operation level zero. -.Dv MOUSE_PROTO_SYSMOUSE -at the operation level one. -.Pp -The -.Dv rate -is always set to -1. -.Pp -The -.Dv resolution -is always set to -1. -.Pp -The -.Dv accelfactor -is always 0. -.Pp -The -.Dv packetsize -field specifies the length of the data packet. It depends on the -operation level. -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width level_0__ -compact -.It Em level 0 -5 bytes -.It Em level 1 -8 bytes -.El -.Pp -The array -.Dv syncmask -holds a bit mask and pattern to detect the first byte of the -data packet. -.Dv syncmask[0] -is the bit mask to be ANDed with a byte. If the result is equal to -.Dv syncmask[1] , -the byte is likely to be the first byte of the data packet. -Note that this method of detecting the first byte is not 100% reliable, -thus, should be taken only as an advisory measure. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_SETMODE Ar mousemode_t *mode -The command changes the current operation parameters of the mouse driver -as specified in -.Ar mode . -Only -.Dv level -may be modifiable. Setting values in the other field does not generate -error and has no effect. -.\" .Pp -.\" .It Dv MOUSE_GETVARS Ar mousevar_t *vars -.\" .It Dv MOUSE_SETVARS Ar mousevar_t *vars -.\" These commands are not supported by the -.\" .Nm -.\" driver. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_READDATA Ar mousedata_t *data -.It Dv MOUSE_READSTATE Ar mousedata_t *state -These commands are not supported by the -.Nm -driver. -.Pp -.It Dv MOUSE_GETSTATUS Ar mousestatus_t *status -The command returns the current state of buttons and -movement counts in the structure as defined in -.Xr mouse 4 . -.El -.Ss Console and Consolectl Ioctls -The user process issues console -.Fn ioctl -calls to the current virtual console in order to control -the mouse pointer. -The console -.Fn ioctl -also provides a method for the user process to receive a -.Xr signal 3 -when a button is pressed. -.Pp -The mouse daemon -.Xr moused 8 -uses -.Fn ioctl -calls to the console control device -.Pa /dev/consolectl -to inform the console of mouse actions including mouse movement -and button status. -.Pp -Both classes -.Fn ioctl -commands are defined as -.Dv CONS_MOUSECTL -which takes the following argument. -.Bd -literal -struct mouse_info { - int operation; - union { - struct mouse_data data; - struct mouse_mode mode; - struct mouse_event event; - } u; -}; -.Ed -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width operation -compact -.It Dv operation -This can be one of -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE_MOVEABS -compact -.It Dv MOUSE_SHOW -Enables and displays mouse cursor. -.It Dv MOUSE_HIDE -Disables and hides mouse cursor. -.It Dv MOUSE_MOVEABS -Moves mouse cursor to position supplied in -.Dv u.data . -.It Dv MOUSE_MOVEREL -Adds position supplied in -.Dv u.data -to current position. -.It Dv MOUSE_GETINFO -Returns current mouse position in the current virtual console -and button status in -.Dv u.data . -.It Dv MOUSE_MODE -This sets the -.Xr signal 3 -to be delivered to the current process when a button is pressed. -The signal to be delivered is set in -.Dv u.mode . -.El -.Pp -The above operations are for virtual consoles. The operations defined -below are for the console control device and used by -.Xr moused 8 -to pass mouse data to the console driver. -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE_MOVEABS -compact -.It Dv MOUSE_ACTION -.It Dv MOUSE_MOTIONEVENT -These operations take the information in -.Dv u.data -and act upon it. Mouse data will be sent to the -.Nm -driver if it is open. -.Dv MOUSE_ACTION -also processes button press actions and sends signal to the process if -requested or performs cut and paste operations -if the current console is a text interface. -.It Dv MOUSE_BUTTONEVENT -.Dv u.data -specifies a button and its click count. The console driver will -use this information for signal delivery if requested or -for cut and paste operations if the console is in text mode. -.El -.Pp -.Dv MOUSE_MOTIONEVENT -and -.Dv MOUSE_BUTTONEVENT -are newer interface and are designed to be used together. -They are intended to replace functions performed by -.Dv MOUSE_ACTION -alone. -.Pp -.It Dv u -This union is one of -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width data -compact -.It Dv data -.Bd -literal -struct mouse_data { - int x; - int y; - int z; - int buttons; -}; -.Ed -.Pp -.Dv x , -.Dv y -and -.Dv z -represent movement of the mouse along respective directions. -.Dv buttons -tells the state of buttons. It encodes up to 31 buttons in the bit 0 though -the bit 30. If a button is held down, the corresponding bit is set. -.Pp -.It Dv mode -.Bd -literal -struct mouse_mode { - int mode; - int signal; -}; -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Dv signal -field specifies the signal to be delivered to the process. It must be -one of the values defined in -.Ao Pa signal.h Ac . -The -.Dv mode -field is currently unused. -.Pp -.It Dv event -.Bd -literal -struct mouse_event { - int id; - int value; -}; -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Dv id -field specifies a button number as in -.Dv u.data.buttons . -Only one bit/button is set. -The -.Dv value -field -holds the click count: the number of times the user has clicked the button -successively. -.Pp -.El -.El -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width /dev/consolectl -compact -.It Pa /dev/consolectl -device to control the console -.It Pa /dev/sysmouse -virtualized mouse driver -.It Pa /dev/ttyv%d -virtual consoles -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr vidcontrol 1 , -.Xr ioctl 2 , -.Xr signal 3 , -.Xr mouse 4 , -.Xr moused 8 -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -manual page example first appeared in -.Fx 2.2 . -.Sh AUTHORS -This -manual page was written by -.An John-Mark Gurney Aq gurney_j@efn.org -and -.An Kazutaka Yokota Aq yokota@FreeBSD.org . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ti.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ti.4 deleted file mode 100644 index b74249001114..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ti.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,192 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998, 1999 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd March 4, 1999 -.Dt TI 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm ti -.Nd -Alteon Networks Tigon I and Tigon II gigabit ethernet driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device ti0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI gigabit ethernet adapters based on -the Alteon Networks Tigon gigabit ethernet controller chip. The Tigon -contains an embedded R4000 CPU, gigabit MAC, dual DMA channels and -a PCI interface unit. The Tigon II contains two R4000 CPUs and other -refinements. Either chip can be used in either a 32-bit or 64-bit PCI -slot. Communication with the chip is achieved via PCI shared memory -and bus master DMA. The Tigon I and II support hardware multicast -address filtering, VLAN tag extraction and insertion, and jumbo -ethernet frames sizes up to 9000 bytes. Note that the Tigon I chipset -is no longer in active production: all new adapters should come equipped -with Tigon II chipsets. -.Pp -There are several PCI boards available from both Alteon and other -vendors that use the Tigon chipset under OEM contract. The -.Nm -driver has been tested with the following Tigon-based adapters: -.Bl -bullet -offset indent -.It -The Alteon AceNIC V gigabit ethernet adapter -.It -The 3Com 3c985-SX gigabit ethernet adapter -.It -The Netgear GA620 gigabit ethernet adapter -.El -.Pp -The following should also be supported but have not yet been tested: -.Bl -bullet -offset indent -.It -The Digital EtherWORKS 1000SX PCI Gigabit Adapter -.It -Silicon Graphics PCI gigabit ethernet adapter -.El -.Pp -While the Tigon chipset supports 10, 100 and 1000Mbps speeds, support for -10 and 100Mbps speeds is only available on boards with the proper -transceivers. Most adapters are only designed to work at 1000Mbps, -however the driver should support those NICs that work at lower speeds -as well. -.Pp -Support for jumbo frames is provided via the interface MTU setting. -Selecting an MTU larger than 1500 bytes with the -.Xr ifconfig 8 -utility configures the adapter to receive and transmit jumbo frames. -Using jumbo frames can greatly improve performance for certain tasks, -such as file transfers and data streaming. -.Pp -Support for vlans is also available using the -.Xr vlan 4 -mechanism. See the -.Xr vlan 4 -man page for more details. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. -The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -file. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.It 1000baseSX -Set 1000Mbps (gigabit ethernet) operation. Only full -.Ar full-duplex -mode is supported at this speed. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "ti%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "ti%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "ti%d: no memory for softc struct!" -The driver failed to allocate memory for per-device instance information -during initialization. -.It "ti%d: failed to enable memory mapping!" -The driver failed to initialize PCI shared memory mapping. This might -happen if the card is not in a bus-master slot. -.It "ti%d: no memory for jumbo buffers!" -The driver failed to allocate memory for jumbo frames during -initialization. -.It "ti%d: bios thinks we're in a 64 bit slot, but we aren't" -The BIOS has programmed the NIC as though it had been installed in -a 64-bit PCI slot, but in fact the NIC is in a 32-bit slot. This happens -as a result of a bug in some BIOSes. This can be worked around on the -Tigon II, but on the Tigon I initialization will fail. -.It "ti%d: board self-diagnostics failed!" -The ROMFAIL bit in the CPU state register was set after system -startup, indicating that the on-board NIC diagnostics failed. -.It "ti%d: unknown hwrev" -The driver detected a board with an unsupported hardware revision. The -.Nm -driver supports revision 4 (Tigon 1) and revision 6 (Tigon 2) chips -and has firmware only for those devices. -.It "ti%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr vlan 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 , -.Rs -.%T Alteon Gigabit Ethernet/PCI NIC manuals -.%O http://www.alteon.com/support/openkits -.Re -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ctr.columbia.edu . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/tl.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/tl.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 3591a6dab733..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/tl.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,127 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd May 1, 1998 -.Dt TL 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm tl -.Nd -Texas Instruments ThunderLAN ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device tl0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI ethernet adapters based on the Texas -Instruments ThunderLAN ethernet controller chip. This includes a large -number of Compaq PCI-bus ethernet adapters as well as the integrated -ethernet controllers built in to several models of Compaq Prosignia -servers and Compaq Deskpro desktop machines. This driver also supports -the Olicom OC-2135/2138, OC-2325 and OC-2326 10/100 TX UTP adapters -and the Racore 8165 10/100baseTX and 8148 10baseT/100baseTX/100baseFX -multi-personality cards. -.Pp -The ThunderLAN controller has a standard MII interface that supports -up to 32 physical interface devices (PHYs). It also has a built-in -10baseT PHY hardwired at MII address 31, which may be used in some -10Mbps-only hardware configurations. In 100Mbps configurations, a -National Semiconductor DP83840A or other MII-compliant PHY may be -attached to the ThunderLAN's MII bus. If a DP83840A or equivalent -is available, the ThunderLAN chip can operate at either 100Mbps or -10Mbps in either half-duplex or full-duplex modes. The ThunderLAN's -built-in PHY and the DP83840A also support autonegotiation. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. Note that this -option is only available on those PHYs that support autonegotiation. -Also, the PHY will not advertise those modes that have been explcitly -disabled using the following media options. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation -.It 10base5/AUI -Enable AUI/BNC interface (useful only with the built-in PHY). -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.It hw-loopback -Enable hardware loopback mode. -.El -.Pp -Note that the 100baseTX media type is only available if supported -by the PHY. -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "tl%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "tl%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "tl%d: device timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.It "tl%d: no memory for rx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the receiver ring. -.It "tl%d: no memory for tx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the transmitter ring when -allocating a pad buffer or collapsing an mbuf chain into a cluster. -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 2.2 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ctr.columbia.edu . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/uhci.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/uhci.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 4d06dc652308..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/uhci.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,70 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1999 -.\" Nick Hibma . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY NICK HIBMA AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL NICK HIBMA OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd February 21, 1999 -.Dt UHCI 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm uhci -.Nd -UHCI USB Host Controller Driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "controller uhci0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for UHCI-type PCI based USB controllers. This -includes -.Bl -tag -width xxxxx -.It Intel 82371AB/EB (PIIX4) -.It Intel 82371SB (PIIX3) -.It VIA 83C572 -.El - -or any other UHCI v1.1 compliant controller. -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr ohci 4 -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Lennart Augustsson Aq augustss@carlstedt.se -for the -.Nx -project. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ukbd.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ukbd.4 deleted file mode 100644 index b906bda8adce..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ukbd.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,168 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998 -.\" Nick Hibma . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY NICK HIBMA AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL NICK HIBMA OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd April 11, 1999 -.Dt UKBD 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm ukbd -.Nd USB keyboard driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device ukbd0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for keyboards that attach to the USB port. -.Nm usb -and one of -.Nm uhci -or -.Nm ohci -must be configured in the kernel as well. -.Sh CONFIGURATION -By default the keyboard subsystem does not create the appropriate devices yet. -Make sure you configure compile the kernel with the following option in the -kernel config file: -.Bd -literal -offset indent -options "KBD_INSTALL_CDEV" -.Ed -.Pp -Go to /dev and make device nodes kbd*: -.Bd -literal -offset indent -sh MAKEDEV kbd0 kbd1 -.Ed -.Pp -If both an AT keyboard as well as USB keyboards are used at the same time, the -AT keyboard will appear as kbd0 in /dev. The USB keyboards will be kbd1, kbd2, -etc. You can see some information about the keyboard with the following command: -.Bd -literal -offset indent -kbdcontrol -i < /dev/kbd1 -.Ed -.Pp -or load a keymap with -.Bd -literal -offset indent -kbdcontrol -l keymaps/pt.iso < /dev/kbd1 -.Ed -.Pp -See -.Nm kbcontrol -for more possible options. -.Pp -You can swap console keyboards by using the command -.Bd -literal -offset indent -kbdcontrol -k /dev/kbd1 -.Ed -.Pp -From this point on onwards the first USB keyboard will be the keyboard -to be used as the console. -.Pp -If you want to use a USB keyboard as your default and not use an AT keyboard at -all, you will have to remove the -.Nm atkbd0 -from the kernel configuration file. Because of the order of the device -initialisation, the USB keyboard will be detected AFTER the console driver -initialises itself and you have to explicitly tellthe console -driver to use the existence of the USB keyboard. This can be done in -one of the following two ways. -.Pp -Run the following command as a part of system initialization: -.Bd -literal -offset indent -kbdcontrol -k /dev/kbd0 < /dev/ttyv0 > /dev/null -.Ed -.Pp -(Note that as the USB keyboard is the only keyboard, it is accessed as -/dev/kbd0) or otherwise tell the console driver to periodically look for a -keyboard by setting a flag in the kernel configuration file: -.Bd -literal -offset indent -device sc0 at isa? flags 0x100 -.Ed -.Pp -With the above flag, the console driver will try to detect any -keyboard in the system if it didn't detect one while it was -initialized at boot time. -.Sh DRIVER CONFIGURATION -.Bd -literal -offset indent -options "KBD_INSTALL_CDEV" -.Ed -.Pp -Make the keyboards available through a character device in /dev -.Bd -literal -offset indent -options "UKBD_DFLT_KEYMAP" -makeoptions "UKBD_DFLT_KEYMAP=fr.iso" -.Ed -.Pp -The above lines will put the French ISO keymap in the ukbd driver. -You can specify any keymap in /usr/share/syscons/keymaps with this -option. -.Bd -literal -offset indent -options "KBD_DISABLE_KEYMAP_LOADING" -.Ed -.Pp -Don't allow the user to change the keymap. Note that this options -also has effect on the AT keyboard driver `atkbd'. -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width /dev/kbd0 -compact -.It Pa /dev/kbd* -blocking device nodes -.Sh EXAMPLE -.Bd -literal -offset indent -device ukbd0 -.Ed -.Pp -Add the -.Nm ukbd -driver to the kernel. -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr kbdcontrol 1 , -.Xr ohci 4 , -.Xr syscons 4 , -.Xr uhci 4 , -.Xr usb 4 , -.Xr config 8 -.\".Sh HISTORY -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm ukbd -driver was written by -.An Lennart Augustsson Aq augustss@cs.chalmers.se -for -.Nx -and was substantially rewritten for -.Fx -by -.An Kazutaka YOKOTA Aq yokota@zodiac.mech.utsunomiya-u.ac.jp . -.Pp -This manual page was written by -.An Nick Hibma Aq hibma@skylink.it -with a large amount of input from -.An Kazutaka YOKOTA Aq yokota@zodiac.mech.utsunomiya-u.ac.jp . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/umass.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/umass.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 49f3434d7cd8..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/umass.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,104 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1999 -.\" Nick Hibma . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY NICK HIBMA AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL NICK HIBMA OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd May 3, 1999 -.Dt UMASS 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm umass -.Nd USB Mass Storage Devices Driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "controller umass0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for Mass Storage devices that attach to the USB -port. Supported are -.Bl -tag -compact -width xxxxxx -.It Iomega Zip 100 drive -.El -.Nm usb -and one of -.Nm uhci -or -.Nm ohci -must be configured in the kernel as well. Last but not least, support for -SCSI drives, -.Nm da -.Sh EXAMPLE -.Dl controller umass0 -.Dl controller scbus0 -.Dl device da0 -.Dl device pass0 -.Pp -Add the -.Nm umass -driver to the kernel. -.Pp -.Dl camcontrol rescan 0 -.Pp -Rescan a Zip drive that was added after boot. The command above -assumes that the Zip drive is the first SCSI bus in the system. -.Pp -.Dl disklabel -w -r da0 zip100 -.Dl newfs da0c -.Dl mount -t ufs /dev/da0c /mnt -.Pp -Write a disklabel to the Zip drive (see -.Nm vpo -for the -.Nm disktab -entry), creates the filesystem and mounts the new filesystem on /mnt. -.Pp -.Dl newfs_msdos /dev/da0 -.Pp -Create a new FAT type filesystem. -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr ohci 4 , -.Xr uhci 4 , -.Xr usb 4 , -.Xr vpo 4 , -.Xr disktab 5 , -.Xr camcontrol 8 , -.Xr disklabel 8 -.\".Sh HISTORY -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm umass -driver was written by -.An MAEKAWA Masahide Aq bishop@rr.iij4u.or.jp -and -.An Nick Hibma Aq hibma@skylink.it . -.Pp -This manual page was written by -.An Nick Hibma Aq hibma@skylink.it . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ums.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ums.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 4986d0de3d0c..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/ums.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,123 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1999 -.\" Nick Hibma . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY NICK HIBMA AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL NICK HIBMA OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd April 11, 1999 -.Dt UMS 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm ums -.Nd USB mouse driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device ums0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for mice that attach to the USB port. Supported are -mice with any number of buttons and mice with a wheel. -.Nm usb -and one of -.Nm uhci -or -.Nm ohci -must be configured in the kernel as well. -.Pp -The /dev/ums device presents the mouse as a -.Ar sysmouse -or -.Ar mousesystems -type device. See -.Nm moused -for an explanation of these mouse types. -.Sh FILES -.Bl -tag -width /dev/ums0 -compact -.It Pa /dev/ums0 -blocking device node -.Sh EXAMPLE -.Dl device ums0 -.Pp -Add the -.Nm ums -driver to the kernel. -.Pp -.Dl moused -p /dev/ums0 -t auto -.Pp -Use the first -.Nm USB -mouse on the system as your console mouse. -.Pp -Change the "Pointer" section in -.Nm XF86Config -to the following -.Pp -.Dl Device "/dev/ums0" -.Dl Protocol "Auto" -.Pp -to be able to use the USB mouse under X. When using the XiG accelerated X -server, change the mouse device to /dev/ums0 and the mouse type to -"MouseSystems". -.Pp -If you want to be able to use the mouse in both virtual consoles as well -as in X change it to: -.Pp -.Dl Device "/dev/sysmouse" -.Dl Protocol "Auto" -.Pp -For XFree86 3.3.1 the entry should be: -.Pp -.Dl Device "/dev/sysmouse" -.Dl Protocol "MouseSystems" -.Pp -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr ohci 4 , -.Xr sysmouse 4 , -.Xr uhci 4 , -.Xr usb 4 , -.Xr XF86Config 5 , -.Xr moused 8 -.\".Sh HISTORY -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm ums -driver was written by -.An Lennart Augustsson Aq augustss@cs.chalmers.se -for -.Nx -and was adopted for -.Fx -by -.An MAEKAWA Masahide Aq bishop@rr.iij4u.or.jp . -.Pp -This manual page was written by -.An Nick Hibma Aq hibma@skylink.it -with input from -.An Kazutaka YOKOTA Aq yokota@zodiac.mech.utsunomiya-u.ac.jp . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/usb.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/usb.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 0bda07c22bd5..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/usb.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,298 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998 -.\" Nick Hibma . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY NICK HIBMA AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL NICK HIBMA OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd February 21, 1999 -.Dt USB 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm usb -.Nd Universal Serial Bus -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "controller usb0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -.Fx -provides machine-independent bus support and drivers for -.Tn USB -devices. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver has three layers: the controller, the bus, and the -device layer. The controller attaches to a physical bus -(like -.Xr pci 4 ). -The -.Tn USB -bus attaches to the controller and the root hub attaches -to the controller. -Any devices attached to the bus will attach to the root hub -or another hub attached to the USB bus. -.Pp -The -.Nm uhub -device will always be present as it is needed for the -root hub. -.Pp -.Sh INTRODUCTION TO USB -The -.Tn USB -is a 12 Mb/s serial bus (1.5 Mb/s for low speed devices). -Each -.Tn USB -has a host controller that is the master of the bus; -all other devices on the bus only speak when spoken to. -.Pp -There can be up to 127 devices (apart from the host controller) -on a bus, each with its own address. -The addresses are assigned -dynamically by the host when each device is attached to the bus. -.Pp -Within each device there can be up to 16 endpoints. -Each endpoint -is individually addressed and the addresses are static. -Each of these endpoints will communicate in one of four different modes: -control, isochronous, bulk, or interrupt. -A device always has at least one endpoint. -This endpoint has address 0 and is a control -endpoint and is used to give commands to and extract basic data, -such as descriptors, from the device. -Each endpoint, except the control endpoint, is unidirectional. -.Pp -The endpoints in a device are grouped into interfaces. -An interface is a logical unit within a device; e.g. -a compound device with both a keyboard and a trackball would present -one interface for each. -An interface can sometimes be set into different modes, -called alternate settings, which affects how it operates. -Different alternate settings can have different endpoints -within it. -.Pp -A device may operate in different configurations. -Depending on the -configuration the device may present different sets of endpoints -and interfaces. -.Pp -Each device located on a hub has several -.Xr config 8 -locators: -.Bl -tag -compact -width xxxxxx -.It Cd port -this is the number of the port on the closest upstream hub. -.It Cd configuration -this is the configuration the device must be in for this driver to attach. -This locator does not set the configuration; it is iterated by the bus -enumeration. -.It Cd interface -this is the interface number within a device that an interface driver -attaches to. -.El -.Pp -The bus enumeration of the -.Tn USB -bus proceeds in several steps: -.Bl -enum -.It -Any device specific driver can to attach to the device. -.It -If none is found, any device class specific driver can attach. -.It -If none is found, all configurations are iterated over. -For each configuration all the interface are iterated over and interface -drivers can attach. -If any interface driver attached in a certain -configuration the iteration over configurations is stopped. -.It -If still no drivers have been found, the generic -.Tn USB -driver can attach. -.El -.Sh USB CONTROLLER INTERFACE -Use the following to get access to the -.Tn USB -specific structurs and defines. -.Bd -literal -#include -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Pa /dev/usbN -can be opened and a few operations can be performed on it. -The -.Xr poll 2 -system call will say that I/O is possible on the controller device when a -.Tn USB -device has been connected or disconnected to the bus. -.Pp -The following -.Xr ioctl 2 -commands are supported on the controller device: -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxx -.It Dv USB_DISCOVER -This command will cause a complete bus discovery to be initiated. -If any devices attached or detached from the bus they will be -processed during this command. -This is the only way that new devices are found on the bus. -.It Dv USB_DEVICEINFO Fa "struct usb_device_info" -This command can be used to retrieve some information about a device -on the bus. -The -.Va addr -field should be filled before the call and the other fields will -be filled by information about the device on that address. -Should no such device exist an error is reported. -.Bd -literal -struct usb_device_info { - uByte addr; /* device address */ - char product[USB_MAX_STRING_LEN]; - char vendor[USB_MAX_STRING_LEN]; - char revision[8]; - uByte class; - uByte config; - uByte lowspeed; - int power; - int nports; - uByte ports[16]; -#define USB_PORT_ENABLED 0xff -#define USB_PORT_SUSPENDED 0xfe -#define USB_PORT_POWERED 0xfd -#define USB_PORT_DISABLED 0xfc -}; -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Va product , -.Va vendor , -and -.Va revision -fields contain self-explanatory descriptions of the device. -.Pp -The -.Va class -field contains the device class. -.Pp -The -.Va config -field shows the current configuration of the device. -.Pp -The -.Va lowspeed -field -is set if the device is a -.Tn USB -low speed device. -.Pp -The -.Va power -field shows the power consumption in milli-amps drawn at 5 volts, -or zero if the device is self powered. -.Pp -If the device is a hub the -.Va nports -field is non-zero and the -.Va ports -field contains the addresses of the connected devices. -If no device is connected to a port one of the -.Va USB_PORT_* -values indicates its status. -.It Dv USB_DEVICESTATS Fa "struct usb_device_stats" -This command retrieves statistics about the controller. -.Bd -literal -struct usb_device_stats { - u_long requests[4]; -}; -.Ed -.Pp -The -.Va requests -field is indexed by the transfer kind, i.e. -.Va UE_* , -and indicates how many transfers of each kind that has been completed -by the controller. -.It Dv USB_REQUEST Fa "struct usb_ctl_request" -This command can be used to execute arbitrary requests on the control pipe. -This is -.Em DANGEROUS -and should be used with great care since it -can destroy the bus integrity. -.El -.Pp -The include file -.Aq Pa dev/usb/usb.h -contains definitions for the types used by the various -.Xr ioctl 2 -calls. -The naming convention of the fields for the various -.Tn USB -descriptors exactly follows the naming in the -.Tn USB -specification. -Byte sized fields can be accessed directly, but word (16 bit) -sized fields must be access by the -.Fn UGETW field -and -.Fn USETW field value -macros to handle byte order and alignment properly. -.Pp -The include file -.Aq Pa dev/usb/usbhid.h -similarly contains the definitions for -Human Interface Devices -.Pq Tn HID . -.Sh SEE ALSO -The -.Tn USB -specifications can be found at -.Dv http://www.usb.org/developers/docs.htm . -.Pp -.Xr pci 4 , -.Xr ohci 4 , -.Xr ugen 4 , -.Xr uhci 4 , -.Xr uhid 4 , -.Xr ukbd 4 , -.Xr ulpt 4 , -.Xr ums 4 , -.Xr usbd 8 , -.Xr usbdevs 8 -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Lennart Augustsson Aq augustss@carlstedt.se -for the -.Nx -project. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/vga.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/vga.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 23ae14401b0c..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/vga.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,170 +0,0 @@ -.\" -.\" Copyright (c) 1999 -.\" Kazutaka YOKOTA -.\" All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer as -.\" the first lines of this file unmodified. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES -.\" OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. -.\" IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, -.\" INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT -.\" NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, -.\" DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY -.\" THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT -.\" (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF -.\" THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd June 30, 1999 -.Dt VGA 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm vga -.Nd -generic video card interface -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "options VESA" -.Cd "options VESA_DEBUG=N" -.Cd "options VGA_ALT_SEQACCESS" -.Cd "options VGA_NO_FONT_LOADING" -.Cd "options VGA_NO_MODE_CHANGE" -.Cd "options VGA_SLOW_IOACCESS" -.Cd "options VGA_WIDTH90" -.Cd "device vga0 at isa? port ? conflicts" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver is a generic video card driver which provides access to -video cards. This driver is required for the console driver -.Xr syscons 4 . -The console driver will call the -.Nm -driver to manipulate video hardware (changing video modes, loading font, etc). -.Pp -The keyword -.Em conflicts -is required, as the video card may use I/O ports in the same range -as other drivers. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the standard video cards: MDA, CGA, EGA and VGA. In -addition, the driver can utilize VESA BIOS extensions if the video card -supports them. VESA support can either be statically included in the kernel -or can be loaded as a separate module. -.Pp -In order to statically link the VESA support to the kernel, the -.Em VESA -option (see below) must be defined in the kernel configuration file. -.Pp -The -.Nm vesa -module can be dynamically loaded into the kernel using -.Xr kldload 8 . -.Sh DRIVER CONFIGURATION -.Ss Kernel Configuration Options -The following kernel configuration options -.Pq see Xr config 8 -can be used to control the -.Nm -driver. -These options provide compatibility with certain VGA cards. -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE -.It Em VGA_ALT_SEQACCESS -You may want to try this option if the mouse pointer is not drawn correctly -or the font does not seem to be loaded properly on the VGA card. -However, it may cause flicker on some systems. -.It Em VGA_SLOW_IOACCESS -Older VGA cards may require this option for proper operation. -It makes the driver perform byte-wide I/O to VGA registers and -slow down a little. -.It Em VGA_WIDTH90 -This option enables 90 column modes: 90x25, 90x30, 90x43, 90x50, 90x60. -These modes are not always supported by the video card and the display. -It is highly likely that LCD display cannot work with these modes. -.El -.Pp -The following options add optional features to the driver. -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE -.It Em VESA -Add VESA BIOS support to the driver. -If the VGA card has the VESA BIOS extension 1.2 or later, -this option will utilize the VESA BIOS service to switch to high -resolution modes. -.It Em VESA_DEBUG=N -Set the VESA support debug level to -.Fa N . -The default value is zero, which suppresses all debugging output. -.El -.Pp -The following options will remove some features from the -.Nm -driver and save kernel memory. -.Bl -tag -width MOUSE -.It Em VGA_NO_FONT_LOADING -The -.Nm -driver can load software font to EGA and VGA cards. -This option removes this feature. -.It Em VGA_NO_MODE_CHANGE -This option prevents the driver from changing video modes. -.El -.\".Sh FILES -.Sh EXAMPLE -Your kernel configuration should normally have: -.Pp -.Dl "device vga0 at isa? port ? conflicts" -.Pp -The following lines should be included in the kernel configuration file -in order to enable the VESA BIOS Extension support. -.Pp -.Dl "options VESA" -.Dl "device vga0 at isa? port ? conflicts" -.Pp -If you do not want VESA support included in the kernel, but -want to use occasionally, do not add the -.Em VESA -option. And load the -.Nm vesa -module as desired: -.Pp -.Dl kldload vesa -.Pp -.\".Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.\".Sh CAVEATS -.\".Sh BUGS -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr syscons 4 , -.Xr config 8 , -.Xr kldload 8 , -.Xr kldunload 8 . -.Sh STANDARD -.Rs -.%T "VESA BIOS Extension (VBE)" -.%A Video Electronics Standards Association -.Re -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.1 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Søren Schmidt Aq sos@FreeBSD.org -and -.An Kazutaka Yokota Aq yokota@FreeBSD.org . -This manual page was written by -.An Kazutaka Yokota . diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/vr.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/vr.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 7b914e8163fa..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/vr.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,165 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd November 22, 1998 -.Dt VR 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm vr -.Nd -VIA Technologies VT3043 and VT86C100A ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device vr0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI ethernet adapters and embedded -controllers based on the VIA Technologies VT3043 Rhine I and -VT86C100A Rhine II fast ethernet controller chips. This includes -the D-Link DFE530-TX, the Hawking Technologies PN102TX, the -AOpen/Acer ALN-320, and various other commodity fast ethernet -cards. -.Pp -The VIA Rhine chips use bus master DMA and have a descriptor layout -designed to resemble that of the DEC 21x4x "tulip" chips. The register -layout is different however and the receive filter in the Rhine chips -is much simpler and is programmed through registers rather than by -downloading a special setup frame through the transmit DMA engine. -Transmit and receive DMA buffers must be longword -aligned. The Rhine chips are meant to be interfaced with external -physical layer devices via an MII bus. They support both -10 and 100Mbps speeds in either full or half duplex. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. -The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -file. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -Note that the 100baseTX media type is only available if supported -by the adapter. -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "vr%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "vr%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "vr%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.It "vr%d: no memory for rx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the receiver ring. -.It "vr%d: no memory for tx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the transmitter ring when -allocating a pad buffer or collapsing an mbuf chain into a cluster. -.It "vr%d: chip is in D3 power state -- setting to D0" -This message applies only to adapters which support power -management. Some operating systems place the controller in low power -mode when shutting down, and some PCI BIOSes fail to bring the chip -out of this state before configuring it. The controller loses all of -its PCI configuration in the D3 state, so if the BIOS does not set -it back to full power mode in time, it won't be able to configure it -correctly. The driver tries to detect this condition and bring -the adapter back to the D0 (full power) state, but this may not be -enough to return the driver to a fully operational condition. If -you see this message at boot time and the driver fails to attach -the device as a network interface, you will have to perform second -warm boot to have the device properly configured. -.Pp -Note that this condition only occurs when warm booting from another -operating system. If you power down your system prior to booting -.Fx , -the card should be configured correctly. -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Rs -.%T The VIA Technologies VT86C100A data sheet -.%O http://www.via.com.tw -.Re -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ctr.columbia.edu . -.Sh BUGS -The -.Nm -driver always copies transmit mbuf chains into longword-aligned -buffers prior to transmission in order to pacify the Rhine chips. -If buffers are not aligned correctly, the chip will round the -supplied buffer address and begin DMAing from the wrong location. -This buffer copying impairs transmit performance on slower systems but can't -be avoided. On faster machines (e.g. a Pentium II), the performance -impact is much less noticable. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/wb.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/wb.4 deleted file mode 100644 index df4de1ce03d3..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/wb.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,159 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd November 4, 1998 -.Dt WB 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm wb -.Nd -Winbond W89C840F fast ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device wb0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI ethernet adapters and embedded -controllers based on the Winbond W89C840F fast ethernet controller -chip. This includes the Trendware TE100-PCIE and various other cheap -boards. The 840F should not be confused with the 940F, which is -an NE2000 clone and only supports 10Mbps speeds. -.Pp -The Winbond controller uses bus master DMA and is designed to be -a DEC 'tulip' workalike. It differs from the standard DEC design -in several ways: the control and status registers are spaced 4 -bytes apart instead of 8, and the receive filter is programmed through -registers rather than by downloading a special setup frame via -the transmit DMA engine. Using an external PHY, the Winbond chip -supports both 10 and 100Mbps speeds in either full or half duplex. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. This is only -supported if the PHY chip attached to the Winbond controller -supports NWAY autonegotiation. The user can manually override -the autoselected mode by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -file. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex -modes. -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -Note that the 100baseTX media type is only available if supported -by the adapter. -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "wb%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "wb%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "wb%d: watchdog timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.It "wb%d: no memory for rx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the receiver ring. -.It "wb%d: no memory for tx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the transmitter ring when -allocating a pad buffer or collapsing an mbuf chain into a cluster. -.It "wb%d: chip is in D3 power state -- setting to D0" -This message applies only to adapters which support power -management. Some operating systems place the controller in low power -mode when shutting down, and some PCI BIOSes fail to bring the chip -out of this state before configuring it. The controller loses all of -its PCI configuration in the D3 state, so if the BIOS does not set -it back to full power mode in time, it won't be able to configure it -correctly. The driver tries to detect this condition and bring -the adapter back to the D0 (full power) state, but this may not be -enough to return the driver to a fully operational condition. If -you see this message at boot time and the driver fails to attach -the device as a network interface, you will have to perform second -warm boot to have the device properly configured. -.Pp -Note that this condition only occurs when warm booting from another -operating system. If you power down your system prior to booting -.Fx , -the card should be configured correctly. -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ctr.columbia.edu . -.Sh BUGS -The Winbond chip seems to behave strangely in some cases when the -link partner switches modes. If for example both sides are set to -10Mbps half-duplex, and the other end is changed to 100Mbps -full-duplex, the Winbond's receiver suddenly starts writing trash -all over the RX descriptors. The -.Nm -driver handles this by forcing a reset of both the controller -chip and attached PHY. This is drastic, but it appears to be the -only way to recover properly from this condition. diff --git a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/xl.4 b/share/man/man4/man4.i386/xl.4 deleted file mode 100644 index 62a76c709e06..000000000000 --- a/share/man/man4/man4.i386/xl.4 +++ /dev/null @@ -1,177 +0,0 @@ -.\" Copyright (c) 1997, 1998 -.\" Bill Paul . All rights reserved. -.\" -.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without -.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions -.\" are met: -.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. -.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright -.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the -.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. -.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software -.\" must display the following acknowledgement: -.\" This product includes software developed by Bill Paul. -.\" 4. Neither the name of the author nor the names of any co-contributors -.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software -.\" without specific prior written permission. -.\" -.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY Bill Paul AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND -.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE -.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE -.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL Bill Paul OR THE VOICES IN HIS HEAD -.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR -.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF -.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS -.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN -.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) -.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF -.\" THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. -.\" -.\" $FreeBSD$ -.\" -.Dd August 16, 1998 -.Dt XL 4 i386 -.Os FreeBSD -.Sh NAME -.Nm xl -.Nd -3Com Etherlink XL and Fast Etherlink XL ethernet device driver -.Sh SYNOPSIS -.Cd "device xl0" -.Sh DESCRIPTION -The -.Nm -driver provides support for PCI ethernet adapters and embedded -controllers based on the 3Com "boomerang" and "cyclone" bus-master -Etherlink XL chips. This includes the 3c900-TP, 3c900-COMBO, 3c905-TX, -3c905-T4, 3c905B-TP, 3c905B-T4 and 3c905B-TX, and embedded 3c905-TX -and 3c905B-TX ethernet hardware in certain Dell Optiplex and Dell -Precision desktop machines, and certain Dell Latitude laptop docking -stations. -.Pp -The Etherlink XL chips support built-in 10baseT, 10base2 and 10base5 -transceivers as well as an MII bus for externally attached PHY -transceivers. The 3c905 series typically uses a National Semiconductor -NS 83840A 10/100 PHY for 10/100 Mbps support in full or half-duplex. -The 3c905B adapters have built-in autonegotiation logic mapped onto -the MII for compatibility with previous drivers. Fast Etherlink XL -adapters such as the 3c905-TX and 3c905B-TX are capable of 10 or -100Mbps data rates in either full or half duplex and can be manually -configured for any supported mode or automatically negotiate the highest -possible mode with a link partner. -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media types: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It autoselect -Enable autoselection of the media type and options. Note that this -option is only available with the 3c905 and 3c905B adapters with -external PHYs or built-in autonegotiation logic. For 3c900 adapters, -the driver will choose the mode specified in the EEPROM. The user can -change this by adding media options to the -.Pa /etc/rc.conf -file. -.It 10baseT/UTP -Set 10Mbps operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can also be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex modes. -.It 100baseTX -Set 100Mbps (fast ethernet) operation. The -.Ar mediaopt -option can abso be used to select either -.Ar full-duplex -or -.Ar half-duplex modes. -.It 10base5/AUI -Enable AUI transceiver (available only on COMBO cards). -.It 10base2/BNC -Enable BNC coax transceiver (available only on COMBO cards). -.El -.Pp -The -.Nm -driver supports the following media options: -.Pp -.Bl -tag -width xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx -.It full-duplex -Force full duplex operation -.It half-duplex -Force half duplex operation. -.El -.Pp -Note that the 100baseTX media type is only available if supported -by the adapter. -For more information on configuring this device, see -.Xr ifconfig 8 . -.Sh DIAGNOSTICS -.Bl -diag -.It "xl%d: couldn't map memory" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "xl%d: couldn't map interrupt" -A fatal initialization error has occurred. -.It "xl%d: device timeout" -The device has stopped responding to the network, or there is a problem with -the network connection (cable). -.It "xl%d: no memory for rx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the receiver ring. -.It "xl%d: no memory for tx list" -The driver failed to allocate an mbuf for the transmitter ring when -allocating a pad buffer or collapsing an mbuf chain into a cluster. -.It "xl%d: command never completed!" -Some commands issued to the 3c90x ASIC take time to complete: the -driver is supposed to wait until the 'command in progress' bit in -the status register clears before continuing. In rare instances, this -bit may not clear. To avoid getting caught in an infinite wait loop, -the driver only polls the bit for a finite number of times before -giving up, at which point it issues this message. This message may -be printed during driver initialization on slower machines. If you -see this message but the driver continues to function normally, the -message can probably be ignored. -.It "xl%d: chip is in D3 power state -- setting to D0" -This message applies only to 3c905B adapters, which support power -management. Some operating systems place the 3c905B in low power -mode when shutting down, and some PCI BIOSes fail to bring the chip -out of this state before configuring it. The 3c905B loses all of -its PCI configuration in the D3 state, so if the BIOS does not set -it back to full power mode in time, it won't be able to configure it -correctly. The driver tries to detect this condition and bring -the adapter back to the D0 (full power) state, but this may not be -enough to return the driver to a fully operational condition. If -you see this message at boot time and the driver fails to attach -the device as a network interface, you will have to perform second -warm boot to have the device properly configured. -.Pp -Note that this condition only occurs when warm booting from another -operating system. If you power down your system prior to booting -.Fx , -the card should be configured correctly. -.It "xl%d: WARNING: no media options bits set in the media options register!" -This warning may appear when using the driver on some Dell Latitude -docking stations with built-in 3c905-TX adapters. For whatever the -reason, the 'MII available' bit in the media options register on -this particular equipment is not set, even though it should be (the -3c905-TX always uses an external PHY transceiver). The driver will -attempt to guess the proper media type based on the PCI device ID -word. The driver makes a lot of noise about this condition because -the author considers it a manufacturing defect. -.El -.Sh SEE ALSO -.Xr arp 4 , -.Xr netintro 4 , -.Xr ifconfig 8 -.Sh HISTORY -The -.Nm -device driver first appeared in -.Fx 3.0 . -.Sh AUTHORS -The -.Nm -driver was written by -.An Bill Paul Aq wpaul@ctr.columbia.edu . -- cgit v1.2.3